blob: 357a67e0bfaf1ce6045b3f164fe1c30833252bd3 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau6e893b92019-03-26 05:40:51 +01007 2019/03/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200583 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100584 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200585 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - ssl-default-bind-options
589 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200591 - ssl-default-server-options
592 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100593 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100594 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100595 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100596 - 51degrees-data-file
597 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200598 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200599 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100600
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200602 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200603 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200604 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100605 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100606 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100607 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200608 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200609 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200610 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200611 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - noepoll
613 - nokqueue
614 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100615 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300616 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000617 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100618 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200619 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200620 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200621 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000622 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000623 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200624 - tune.buffers.limit
625 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200626 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200627 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100628 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200629 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200630 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200631 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100632 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200633 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200634 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100635 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100636 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100637 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100638 - tune.lua.session-timeout
639 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200640 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100641 - tune.maxaccept
642 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200643 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200644 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200645 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100646 - tune.rcvbuf.client
647 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100648 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200649 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100650 - tune.sndbuf.client
651 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100652 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100653 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200654 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100655 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200656 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200657 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100658 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200659 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100660 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200661 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
662 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
663 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100664 - tune.zlib.memlevel
665 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100666
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200667 * Debugging
668 - debug
669 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200670
671
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006723.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200673------------------------------------
674
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200675ca-base <dir>
676 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200677 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
678 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200679
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200680chroot <jail dir>
681 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
682 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
683 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
684 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
685 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100686 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100687
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100688cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
689 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
690 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
691 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
692 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
693 set. These sets have the format
694
695 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
696
697 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100698 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100699 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
700 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100701 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
702 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100704 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100705 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100706 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100707 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
708 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
709 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
710 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100711
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100712 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
713 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
714 on the machine's word size.
715
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100716 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100717 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
718 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
719 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
720 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
721 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
722 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100723
724 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100725 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
726
727 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
728 # first 4 CPUs
729
730 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
731 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
732 # word size.
733
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100734 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100735 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100736 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
737 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
738 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
739
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
741 # and so on.
742 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
743 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
744 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
745
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100746 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100747 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
748 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
749 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
750
751 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
752 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
753 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
754
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
756 # and a thread range.
757 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
759 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
760
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200761crt-base <dir>
762 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
763 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
764 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
765
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200766daemon
767 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
768 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100769 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
770 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200772deviceatlas-json-file <path>
773 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100774 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200775
776deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100777 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200778 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
779
780deviceatlas-separator <char>
781 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
782 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
783
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100784deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200785 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
786 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
787 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100788
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900789external-check
790 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
791 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
792 See "option external-check".
793
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794gid <number>
795 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
796 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
797 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100798 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
799 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200800 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100801
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100802hard-stop-after <time>
803 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
804
805 Arguments :
806 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
807 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
808 SIGUSR1 signal.
809
810 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
811 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
812 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
813
814 Example:
815 global
816 hard-stop-after 30s
817
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200818group <group name>
819 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
820 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100821
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200822log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100823 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100824 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100825 configured with "log global".
826
827 <address> can be one of:
828
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100829 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
831 port).
832
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100833 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
834 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
835 port).
836
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100837 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100838 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
839 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100840 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
843 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
844 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
845 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
846 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
847 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
848 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
849 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
850 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
851 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
852 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
853 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
854 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
855 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100856 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
857 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100858
859 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
860 "fd@2", see above.
861
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200862 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
863 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100864
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200865 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
866 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
867 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
868 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
869 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
870 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
871 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
872 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
873 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
874 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100875 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
876 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200877
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200878 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
879 one of the following :
880
881 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
882 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
883
884 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
885 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
886
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100887 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
888 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
889 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
890 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
891 logger consumes.
892
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100893 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
894 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
895 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
896 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
897
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100898 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200899
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100900 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
901 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
902 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
903
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100904 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
905 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
906 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
907 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200908
909 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200910 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
911 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
912 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
913 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
914 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
915 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200916
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200917 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200918
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100919log-send-hostname [<string>]
920 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
921 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
922 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
923 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
924 the logs.
925
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000926log-tag <string>
927 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
928 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
929 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100930 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100932lua-load <file>
933 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
934 used multiple times.
935
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100936master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200937 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
938 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
939 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100940 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200941 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
942 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100943 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
944 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
945 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
946 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
947 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200948
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100949 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200950
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200951nbproc <number>
952 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
953 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
954 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100955 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
956 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100957 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
958 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200960nbthread <number>
961 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +0100962 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
963 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
964 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
965 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
966 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100967 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
968 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
969 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
970 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
971 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
972 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
973 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200974
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200975pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100976 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200977 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
978 starting the process. See also "daemon".
979
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100980presetenv <name> <value>
981 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
982 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
983 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
984 and "unsetenv".
985
986resetenv [<name> ...]
987 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
988 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
989 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
990 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
991 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
992 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
993 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
994 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
995
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100996stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200997 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
998 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
999 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1000 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1001 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1002 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001003 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001004 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1005 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1006 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1007 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001008
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001009server-state-base <directory>
1010 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001011 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1012 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001013
1014server-state-file <file>
1015 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1016 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1017 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1018 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1019 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1020 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1021 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1022 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001023 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1024 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001025
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001026setenv <name> <value>
1027 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1028 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1029 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1030 and "unsetenv".
1031
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001032set-dumpable
1033 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1034 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1035 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1036 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1037 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1038 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1039 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1040 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1041 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1042 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1043 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1044 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1045 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1046 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1047 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1048 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1049 expected when dying.
1050
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001051ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1053 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001054 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001055 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001056 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1057 information and recommendations see e.g.
1058 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1059 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1060 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1061 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062
1063ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1064 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1065 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1066 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1067 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1068 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001069 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1070 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1071 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001072 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001073
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001074ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1075 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1076 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1077 keyword to see available options.
1078
1079 Example:
1080 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001081 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001082
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001083ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1085 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001086 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001087 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001088 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1089 information and recommendations see e.g.
1090 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1091 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1092 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1093 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1094 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001095
1096ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1097 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1098 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1099 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1100 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1101 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001102 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1103 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1104 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1105 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001106
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001107ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1109 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1110 keyword to see available options.
1111
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001112ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1114 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1115 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001116 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001117 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001118 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1119 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1120 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1121 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001122 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1123 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1124 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1125
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001126ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1127 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1128 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1129 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1130
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001131stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1132 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1133 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1134 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001135 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001136 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001137
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001138 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1139 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1140 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001141
1142stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1143 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1144 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001145 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001146
1147stats maxconn <connections>
1148 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1149 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151uid <number>
1152 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1153 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1154 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1155 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1156
1157ulimit-n <number>
1158 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1159 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1160 option.
1161
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001162unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1163 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1164
1165 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1166 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1167 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1168 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1169 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1170 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1171 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1172 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1173 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1174 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1175
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001176unsetenv [<name> ...]
1177 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1178 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1179 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1180 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1181 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1182 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1183 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1184
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001185user <user name>
1186 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1187 See also "uid" and "group".
1188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001189node <name>
1190 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1191
1192 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1193 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1194 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1195 traffic.
1196
1197description <text>
1198 Add a text that describes the instance.
1199
1200 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1201 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1202 "<" and ">" characters.
1203
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100120451degrees-data-file <file path>
1205 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001206 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001207
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001208 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001209 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1210
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000121151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001212 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1213 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1214 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1215
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001216 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001217 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1218
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200121951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001220 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1221 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1222
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001223 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1224 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1225
122651degrees-cache-size <number>
1227 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1228 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1229 By default, this cache is disabled.
1230
1231 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001232 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1233
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012353.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001236-----------------------
1237
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001238busy-polling
1239 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1240 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1241 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1242 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1243 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1244 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1245 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1246 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1247 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1248 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1249 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1250 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1251 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1252 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1253 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1254 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1255 "poll" pollers.
1256
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001257max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1258 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1259 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1260 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1261 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1262 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1263 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1264 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1265 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1266
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001267maxconn <number>
1268 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1269 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1270 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001271 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1272 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1273 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1274 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001275 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1276 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1277 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1278 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1279 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1280 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001281
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001282maxconnrate <number>
1283 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1284 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1285 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1286 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1287 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1288 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1289 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1290 fairness.
1291
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001292maxcomprate <number>
1293 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001294 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001295 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1296 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1297 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001298 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001299 default value.
1300
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001301maxcompcpuusage <number>
1302 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1303 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1304 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1305 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1306 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1307 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1308 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1309 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1310
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001311maxpipes <number>
1312 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1313 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1314 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1315 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1316 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1317 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1318
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001319maxsessrate <number>
1320 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1321 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1322 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1323 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1324 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1325 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1326 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1327 fairness.
1328
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001329maxsslconn <number>
1330 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1331 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1332 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1333 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1334 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1335 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1336 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001337 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1338 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1339 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1340 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1341 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1342 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1343 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001344
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001345maxsslrate <number>
1346 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1347 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1348 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1349 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1350 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1351 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1352 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1353 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1354 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1355 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1356
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001357maxzlibmem <number>
1358 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1359 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1360 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001361 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1362 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1363 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1364
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001365noepoll
1366 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1367 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001368 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001369
1370nokqueue
1371 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1372 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1373 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1374
1375nopoll
1376 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1377 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001378 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001379 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001380
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001381nosplice
1382 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001383 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001384 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001385 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001386 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1387 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1388 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1389 "option splice-response".
1390
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001391nogetaddrinfo
1392 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1393 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1394
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001395noreuseport
1396 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1397 command line argument "-dR".
1398
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001399profiling.tasks { on | off }
1400 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1401 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1402 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1403 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1404 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1405 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1406 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1407 CLI.
1408
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001409spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001410 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1411 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1412 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1413 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1414 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1415 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001416
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001417ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001418 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001419 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001420 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1421 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1422 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1423 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1424 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001425 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1426 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001427 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1428 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1429 openssl configuration file uses:
1430 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1431
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001432ssl-mode-async
1433 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001434 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001435 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1436 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1437 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1438 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1439 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001440
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001441tune.buffers.limit <number>
1442 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1443 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1444 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1445 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1446 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001447 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001448 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1449 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1450 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1451 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1452 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1453 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1454 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1455 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1456 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1457
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001458tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1459 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1460 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1461 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1462 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1463
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001464tune.bufsize <number>
1465 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1466 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1467 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1468 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1469 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1470 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1471 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001472 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1473 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1474 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001475 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001476 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1477 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1478 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001479
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001480tune.chksize <number>
1481 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1482 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1483 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1484 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1485 checks whenever possible.
1486
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001487tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1488 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1489 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1490 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1491 this value. The default value is 1.
1492
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001493tune.fail-alloc
1494 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1495 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1496 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1497 gracefully.
1498
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001499tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1500 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1501 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1502 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1503 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1504 change it.
1505
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001506tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1507 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001508 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1509 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001510 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1511 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1512 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1513 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1514 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1515
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001516tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1517 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1518 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1519 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1520 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1521 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1522 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1523 recommended not to change this value.
1524
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001525tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1526 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1527 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1528 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1529 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1530 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1531 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1532 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1533
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001534tune.http.cookielen <number>
1535 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1536 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1537 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1538 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1539 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1540 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1541 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1542 to change this value.
1543
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001544tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001545 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1546 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001547 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001548 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001549 configuration directives too.
1550 The default value is 1024.
1551
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001552tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1553 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1554 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1555 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1556 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1557 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1558 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001559 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1560 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1561 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001562
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001563tune.idletimer <timeout>
1564 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1565 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1566 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1567 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1568 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1569 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001570 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001571 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1572 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1573
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001574tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1575 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1576 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1577 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1578 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1579 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1580 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1581 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1582 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1583 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1584
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001585tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1586 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001587 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001588 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1589 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001590 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001591 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1592 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1593
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001594tune.lua.maxmem
1595 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1596 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1597 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1598 memory.
1599
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001600tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1601 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001602 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1603 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001604 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001605
1606tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1607 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1608 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1609 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1610 check servers.
1611
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001612tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1613 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1614 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1615 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001616 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001617
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001618tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001619 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1620 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1621 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1622 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1623 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1624 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1625 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1626 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1627 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1628 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001629
1630tune.maxpollevents <number>
1631 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1632 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1633 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1634 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1635 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1636
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001637tune.maxrewrite <number>
1638 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1639 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1640 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1641 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1642 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1643 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1644 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1645 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1646 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1647 bufsize.
1648
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001649tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1650 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1651 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1652 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1653 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1654 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1655 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1656 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1657 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1658 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1659 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1660 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1661 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1662 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1663 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1664 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1665 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1666 setting this parameter to 0.
1667
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001668tune.pipesize <number>
1669 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1670 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1671 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1672 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1673 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1674 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1675
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001676tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1677tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1678 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1679 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1680 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1681 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001682 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001683 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1684 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1685
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001686tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001687 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001688 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1689 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1690 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1691 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1692
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001693tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1694 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1695 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1696 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1697
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001698tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1699tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1700 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1701 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1702 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1703 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001704 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001705 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1706 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1707 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1708 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1709 notifying haproxy again.
1710
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001711tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001712 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1713 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1714 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001715 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001716 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001717 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001718 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1719 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1720 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001721 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1722 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001723
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001724tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001725 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001726 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1727 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1728 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1729 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1730 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1731
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001732tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1733 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001734 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001735 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1736 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1737 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1738 being used for too long.
1739
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001740tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1741 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1742 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1743 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1744 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1745 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1746 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1747 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1748 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1749 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1750 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001751 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001752 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001753
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001754tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1755 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1756 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1757 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1758 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1759 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1760 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1761 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001762 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1763 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001764
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001765tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1766 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1767 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1768 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1769 1000 entries.
1770
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001771tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1772 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1773 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1774 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1775
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001776tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001777tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001778tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1779tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1780tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001781 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1782 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1783 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1784 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1785 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1786 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1787 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1788 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001789
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001790 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1791 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1792 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1793 all available space is consumed.
1794 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1795 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1796 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001797
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001798tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1799 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001800 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001801 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001802 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001803 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1804
1805tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1806 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1807 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001808 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1809 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001810
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018113.3. Debugging
1812--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001813
1814debug
1815 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1816 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1817 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1818 system startup.
1819
1820quiet
1821 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1822 line argument "-q".
1823
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018253.4. Userlists
1826--------------
1827It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1828http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1829it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1830
1831userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001832 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001833 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1834
1835group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001836 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001837 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1838 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1839
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001840user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1841 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001842 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1843 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001844 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1845 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1846 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1847 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001848
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001849 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1850 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1851 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1852 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1853 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1854 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1855 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1856 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1857 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001858
1859 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001860 userlist L1
1861 group G1 users tiger,scott
1862 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001863
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001864 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1865 user scott insecure-password elgato
1866 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001867
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001868 userlist L2
1869 group G1
1870 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001871
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001872 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1873 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1874 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001875
1876 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001877
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001878
18793.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001880----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001881It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1882several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1883instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1884values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1885automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1886In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1887using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1888tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1889reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1890Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1891that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1892each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001893
1894peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001895 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001896 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1897
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001898bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1899 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1900 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1901
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001902disabled
1903 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1904 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1905 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1906
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001907default-bind [param*]
1908 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1909
1910default-server [param*]
1911 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1912
1913 Arguments:
1914 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1915 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1916 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1917 details.
1918
1919
1920 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1921
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001922enable
1923 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1924
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001925peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001926 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1927 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1928 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1929 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1930 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1931 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1932
1933 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1934 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1935
1936 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1937 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1938 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1939 across all peers.
1940
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001941 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1942 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001943
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001944 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
1945 "server" keyword explanation below).
1946
1947server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
1948 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
1949 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
1950 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
1951 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
1952 of this "peers" section).
1953 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
1954
1955
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001956 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001957 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001958 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001959 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1960 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1961 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001962
1963 backend mybackend
1964 mode tcp
1965 balance roundrobin
1966 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1967 stick on src
1968
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001969 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1970 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001971
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001972 Example:
1973 peers mypeers
1974 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
1975 default-server ssl verify none
1976 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
1977 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001978
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090019793.6. Mailers
1980------------
1981It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1982If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1983in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1984
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001985mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001986 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1987 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1988
1989mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1990 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1991
1992 Example:
1993 mailers mymailers
1994 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1995 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1996
1997 backend mybackend
1998 mode tcp
1999 balance roundrobin
2000
2001 email-alert mailers mymailers
2002 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2003 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2004
2005 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2006 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2007
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002008timeout mail <time>
2009 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2010 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2011 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2012 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2013
2014 Example:
2015 mailers mymailers
2016 timeout mail 20s
2017 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020194. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002022Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002023 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002024 - frontend <name>
2025 - backend <name>
2026 - listen <name>
2027
2028A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2029its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2030section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002031section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002032
2033A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2034connections.
2035
2036A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2037to forward incoming connections.
2038
2039A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2040parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2041
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2043'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2044case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2045
2046Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2047logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2048proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2049However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2050name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2051
2052Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2053and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002054bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002055protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2056modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2057arbitrary criteria.
2058
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002059In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2060a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002061the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002062
2063 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2064 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2065 between responses and new requests.
2066
2067 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2068 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2069 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002070 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2071 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2072 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2073 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002074
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002075 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2076 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2077 client-facing connection remains open.
2078
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002079 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2080 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002081
2082The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2083frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2084following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002085weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002086
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002087 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002088
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002089 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2090 ----+-----+-----+----
2091 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2092 ----+-----+-----+----
2093 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2094 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2095 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2096 ----+-----+-----+----
2097 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002098
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021014.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2102--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002104The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2105limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2106they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2107limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002108marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002109option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002110and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2111with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2112specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002113
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002114
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002115 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2116------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2117acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002118appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002119backlog X X X -
2120balance X - X X
2121bind - X X -
2122bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002123block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002124capture cookie - X X -
2125capture request header - X X -
2126capture response header - X X -
2127clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002128compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002129contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2130cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002131declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002132default-server X - X X
2133default_backend X X X -
2134description - X X X
2135disabled X X X X
2136dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002137email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002138email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002139email-alert mailers X X X X
2140email-alert myhostname X X X X
2141email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002142enabled X X X X
2143errorfile X X X X
2144errorloc X X X X
2145errorloc302 X X X X
2146-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2147errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002148force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002149filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002150fullconn X - X X
2151grace X X X X
2152hash-type X - X X
2153http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002154http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002155http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002156http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002157http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002158http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002159http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002160id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002161ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002162load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002163log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002164log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002165log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002166log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002167max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002168maxconn X X X -
2169mode X X X X
2170monitor fail - X X -
2171monitor-net X X X -
2172monitor-uri X X X -
2173option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2174option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2175option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2176option allbackups (*) X - X X
2177option checkcache (*) X - X X
2178option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2179option contstats (*) X X X -
2180option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2181option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002182option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002183-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2184option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002185option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002186option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002187option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002188option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002189option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002190option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002191option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002192option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002193option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002194option httpchk X - X X
2195option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002196option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002197option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002198option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002199option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002200option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002201option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2202option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2203option logasap (*) X X X -
2204option mysql-check X - X X
2205option nolinger (*) X X X X
2206option originalto X X X X
2207option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002208option pgsql-check X - X X
2209option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002210option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002211option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002212option smtpchk X - X X
2213option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2214option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2215option splice-request (*) X X X X
2216option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002217option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002218option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2219option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2220-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002221option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002222option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2223option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2224option tcpka X X X X
2225option tcplog X X X X
2226option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002227external-check command X - X X
2228external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002229persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2230rate-limit sessions X X X -
2231redirect - X X X
2232redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2233redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2234reqadd - X X X
2235reqallow - X X X
2236reqdel - X X X
2237reqdeny - X X X
2238reqiallow - X X X
2239reqidel - X X X
2240reqideny - X X X
2241reqipass - X X X
2242reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002243reqitarpit - X X X
2244reqpass - X X X
2245reqrep - X X X
2246-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002247reqtarpit - X X X
2248retries X - X X
2249rspadd - X X X
2250rspdel - X X X
2251rspdeny - X X X
2252rspidel - X X X
2253rspideny - X X X
2254rspirep - X X X
2255rsprep - X X X
2256server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002257server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002258server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002259source X - X X
2260srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002261stats admin - X X X
2262stats auth X X X X
2263stats enable X X X X
2264stats hide-version X X X X
2265stats http-request - X X X
2266stats realm X X X X
2267stats refresh X X X X
2268stats scope X X X X
2269stats show-desc X X X X
2270stats show-legends X X X X
2271stats show-node X X X X
2272stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002273-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2274stick match - - X X
2275stick on - - X X
2276stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002277stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002278stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002279tcp-check connect - - X X
2280tcp-check expect - - X X
2281tcp-check send - - X X
2282tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002283tcp-request connection - X X -
2284tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002285tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002286tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002287tcp-response content - - X X
2288tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002289timeout check X - X X
2290timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002291timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002292timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2293timeout connect X - X X
2294timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2295timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2296timeout http-request X X X X
2297timeout queue X - X X
2298timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002299timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002300timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2301timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002302timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002303transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002304unique-id-format X X X -
2305unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002306use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002307use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002308------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2309 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002310
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023124.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2313---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314
2315This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2316
2317
2318acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2319 Declare or complete an access list.
2320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2321 no | yes | yes | yes
2322 Example:
2323 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2324 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2325 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002327 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328
2329
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002330appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2331 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2334 no | no | yes | yes
2335 Arguments :
2336 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2337 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2338
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002339 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340 checked in each cookie value.
2341
2342 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2343 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2344 milliseconds.
2345
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002346 request-learn
2347 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2348 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2349 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2350 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2351 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2352 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2353
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002354 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2355 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2356 data following this prefix.
2357
2358 Example :
2359 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2360
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002361 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2362 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002363
2364 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2365 2 modes are currently supported :
2366 - path-parameters :
2367 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2368 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2369 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2370 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2371 - query-string :
2372 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2373 query string.
2374
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002375 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2376 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2377 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002378
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002379 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2380 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
2382
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002383backlog <conns>
2384 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2386 yes | yes | yes | no
2387 Arguments :
2388 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2389 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002390 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002391
2392 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2393 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2394 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2395 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2396 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2397 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2398 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2399 backlog parameter.
2400
2401 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2402 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2403 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2404
2405 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2406
2407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002408balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002409balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002410 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2412 yes | no | yes | yes
2413 Arguments :
2414 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2415 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2416 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2417 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2418
2419 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2420 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2421 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2422 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002423 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002424 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002425 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2426 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2427 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2428 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2429 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2430 it, so that you don't worry.
2431
2432 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2433 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2434 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2435 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2436 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2437 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2438 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2439 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002440
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002441 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2442 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2443 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2444 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2445 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2446 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2447 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2448 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2449
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002450 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002451 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002452 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2453 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002454 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002455 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2456 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2457 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2458 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2459 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002460 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2461 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2462 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2463 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2464 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2465 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002466
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002467 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2468 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2469 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2470 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2471 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2472 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2473 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2474 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002475 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002476 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002477 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2478 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2479 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002481 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2482 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2483 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2484 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2485 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2486 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2487 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2488 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2489 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2490 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2491 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2492 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002493
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002494 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002495 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2496 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2497 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2498 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2499 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2500 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2501 URIs start with a leading "/".
2502
2503 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2504 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2505 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2506 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2507
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002508 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002509 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2510
2511 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002512 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2513 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002514 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2515 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2516 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2517 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002518 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002519 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2520 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002521
2522 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2523 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2524 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2525 server will receive the request.
2526
2527 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2528 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2529 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2530 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2531 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002532 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2533 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2534 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002535
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002536 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2537 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2538 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2539 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2540 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002542 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002543 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2544 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2545 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2546
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002547 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2548 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2549 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2550
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002551 random
2552 random(<draws>)
2553 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002554 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2555 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2556 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2557 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002558 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2559 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2560 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2561 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2562 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2563 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2564 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2565 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2566 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2567 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2568 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2569 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2570 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2571 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2572 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2573 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2574 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2575 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2576 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2577 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002578
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002579 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002580 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002581 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2582 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2583 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2584 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2585 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2586 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002587 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002588 used instead.
2589
2590 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2591 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2592 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2593 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2594
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002595 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2596 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2597 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2598
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002599 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002602 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2603 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002604
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002605 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2606 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2607 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002609 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2610 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2611 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2612 NTLM relies on.
2613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614 Examples :
2615 balance roundrobin
2616 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002617 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002618 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2619 balance hdr(host)
2620 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002621
2622 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2623 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2624
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002625 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002626 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2627 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2628 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2629 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2630
2631 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2632 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2633 defaults to 16 kB.
2634
2635 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2636 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2637
2638 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2639 Round Robin.
2640
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002641 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002642 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2643 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2644 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2645
2646 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2647
2648 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002649 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002650 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2651 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2652 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002653
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002654 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002655
2656
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002657bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2658bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002659 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2661 no | yes | yes | no
2662 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002663 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2664 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2665 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2666 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002667 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002668 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2669 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2670 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2671 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2672 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2673 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2674 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002675 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2676 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2677 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2678 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2679 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2680 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2681 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002682 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2683 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2684 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002685 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2686 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2687 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2688 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002689 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2690 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2691 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002692
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002693 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2694 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002695 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2696 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2697 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002698 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2699 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2700 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2701 the range.
2702
2703 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2704 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2705 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2706 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2707 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2708 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2709 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002710 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002711 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002712
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002713 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002714 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002715 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2716 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2717 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2718 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2719 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2720 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2721
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002722 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2723 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2724 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2725 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002726
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002727 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2728 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2729 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2730 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2731 in a frontend.
2732
2733 Example :
2734 listen http_proxy
2735 bind :80,:443
2736 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002737 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002738
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002739 listen http_https_proxy
2740 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002741 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002742
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002743 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2744 bind ipv6@:80
2745 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2746 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2747
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002748 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002749 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002750
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002751 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2752 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2753 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2754 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2755 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2756
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002757 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002758 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002759
2760
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002761bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002762 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2764 yes | yes | yes | yes
2765 Arguments :
2766 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2767 may be used to override a default value.
2768
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002769 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002770 option may be combined with other numbers.
2771
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002772 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002773 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2774 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2775 missing from all processes.
2776
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002777 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002778 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002779 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2780 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2781 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2782 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2783 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002784 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002785
2786 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2787 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2788 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2789 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2790 and 'even' instances.
2791
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002792 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2793 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2794 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2795 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002796
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002797 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2798 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2799
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002800 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2801 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2802 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2803
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002804 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2805 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2806
2807 Example :
2808 listen app_ip1
2809 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002810 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002811
2812 listen app_ip2
2813 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002814 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002815
2816 listen management
2817 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002818 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002819
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002820 listen management
2821 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2822 bind-process 1-4
2823
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002824 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002825
2826
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002827block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2830 no | yes | yes | yes
2831
2832 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2833 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002834 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002835 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002836 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002837 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2838 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2839 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002840
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002841 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2842 "http-request deny" instead.
2843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002844 Example:
2845 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2846 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2847 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002848 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2849 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2850 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002851
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002852 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2853 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2854 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002855
2856capture cookie <name> len <length>
2857 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2859 no | yes | yes | no
2860 Arguments :
2861 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2862 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2863 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2864 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002865 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002866
2867 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2868 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2869 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2870 right if it exceeds <length>.
2871
2872 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2873 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2874 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2875 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2876
2877 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2878 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2879 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2880
2881 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2882 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2883 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002884 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2885 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2886 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002887
2888 Example:
2889 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2890
2891 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002892 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002893
2894
2895capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002896 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2898 no | yes | yes | no
2899 Arguments :
2900 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002901 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002902 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2903 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2904 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2905
2906 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2907 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2908 it exceeds <length>.
2909
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002910 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002911 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2912 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002913 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2914 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2915 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2916 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002917 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002918 environments to find where the request came from.
2919
2920 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2921 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2922 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2923 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002925 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2926 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2927 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2928 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2929 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002930
2931 Example:
2932 capture request header Host len 15
2933 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002934 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002936 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002937 about logging.
2938
2939
2940capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002941 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2943 no | yes | yes | no
2944 Arguments :
2945 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002946 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002947 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2948 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2949 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2950
2951 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2952 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2953 it exceeds <length>.
2954
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002955 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2957 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2958 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002959 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2960 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2961 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2962 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002964 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2965 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2966 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2967 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2968 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969
2970 Example:
2971 capture response header Content-length len 9
2972 capture response header Location len 15
2973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002974 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002975 about logging.
2976
2977
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002978clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2981 yes | yes | yes | no
2982 Arguments :
2983 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2984 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2985 as explained at the top of this document.
2986
2987 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2988 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2989 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2990 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2991 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2992 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2993 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2994 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002995 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002996 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002997 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002998
2999 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3000 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3001 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3002 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3003 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3004 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3005
3006 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3007 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3008
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003009 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3010 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003011
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003012compression algo <algorithm> ...
3013compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003014compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003015 Enable HTTP compression.
3016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3017 yes | yes | yes | yes
3018 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003019 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3020 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3021 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3022
3023 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003024 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3025 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3026 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003027
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003028 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003029 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003030
3031 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3032 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3033 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3034 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3035 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003036 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003037
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003038 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3039 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3040 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3041 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3042 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3043 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3044 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003045 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003046
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003047 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003048 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003049 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3050 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3051 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3052 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3053 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003054
3055 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3056 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3057 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3058 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3059 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003060 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3061 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3062 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3063 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3064 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003065 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3066 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003067
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003068 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003069 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3070 "Accept-Encoding" header
3071 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003072 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003073 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3074 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3075 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3076 "multipart"
3077 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3078 header
3079 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3080 and later
3081 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3082 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003083 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003084
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003085 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003086
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003087 Examples :
3088 compression algo gzip
3089 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003091
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003092contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3095 yes | no | yes | yes
3096 Arguments :
3097 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3098 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3099 as explained at the top of this document.
3100
3101 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003102 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003103 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003104 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003105 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3106 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3107 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3108
3109 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3110 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3111 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3112 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3113 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3114 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3115
3116 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3117 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3118 instead.
3119
3120 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3121 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3122
3123
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003124cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003125 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3126 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003127 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3130 yes | no | yes | yes
3131 Arguments :
3132 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3133 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3134 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3135 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3136 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3137 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003138 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003139 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3140 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3141
3142 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3143 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3144 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3145 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3146 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3147 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003148 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3149 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003150 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003151 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3152 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003153
3154 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003155 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003156
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003157 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003158 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3159 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003160 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003161 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3162 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3163 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3164 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3165 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3166 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3167 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168
3169 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3170 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3171 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3172 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3173 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3174 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3175 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3176 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3177 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003178 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003179 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3180 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3181 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003182
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003183 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3184 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3185 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003186 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3187 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3188 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3189 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003190 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3191 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3192 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003193
3194 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3195 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3196 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3197 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3198 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3199 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3200 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3201 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3202 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3203
3204 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3205 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3206 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3207 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3208 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3209 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3210 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3211 persistence cookie in the cache.
3212 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3213
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003214 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3215 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3216 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3217 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3218 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003219 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003220 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3221 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3222 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3223 they logout.
3224
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003225 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3226 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3227 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3228 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3229
3230 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3231 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3232 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3233 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3234 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3235 this attribute.
3236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003237 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003238 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003239 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3240 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3241 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3242 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3243 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3244 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003245
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003246 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3247 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3248 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3249 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3250 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3251 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3252 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3253 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003254 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003255 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3256 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3257 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3258 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3259 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3260 the site.
3261
3262 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3263 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3264 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3265 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3266 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3267 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3268 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3269 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3270 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3271 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3272 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3273 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3274 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003275 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003276 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3277 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3278
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003279 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3280 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3281 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3282 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3283 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3284 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3285
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3287 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3288 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3289 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003290
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003291 Examples :
3292 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3293 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3294 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003295 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003296
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003297 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003298
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003299
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003300declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3301 Declares a capture slot.
3302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3303 no | yes | yes | no
3304 Arguments:
3305 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3306
3307 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3308 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3309 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3310 for use in the response.
3311
3312 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003313 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003314 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3315
3316
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003317default-server [param*]
3318 Change default options for a server in a backend
3319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3320 yes | no | yes | yes
3321 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003322 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3323 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3324 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3325 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003326
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003327 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003328 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3329
3330 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003331
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333default_backend <backend>
3334 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | yes | yes | no
3337 Arguments :
3338 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3339
3340 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3341 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3342 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3343 will catch all undetermined requests.
3344
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003345 Example :
3346
3347 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3348 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3349 default_backend dynamic
3350
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003351 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003353
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003354description <string>
3355 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 no | yes | yes | yes
3358 Arguments : string
3359
3360 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3361 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3362 it describes.
3363 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3364
3365
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003366disabled
3367 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3369 yes | yes | yes | yes
3370 Arguments : none
3371
3372 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3373 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3374 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3375 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3376 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3377 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3378 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3379
3380 See also : "enabled"
3381
3382
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003383dispatch <address>:<port>
3384 Set a default server address
3385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3386 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003387 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003388
3389 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3390 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3391 during start-up.
3392
3393 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3394 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3395 possible with normal servers.
3396
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003397 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003398 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3399 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3400 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3401 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3402
3403 See also : "server"
3404
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003405
3406dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3407 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | no | yes | yes
3410 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3411
3412 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003413 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003414 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3415 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003416 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003417 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003418
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419enabled
3420 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3422 yes | yes | yes | yes
3423 Arguments : none
3424
3425 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3426 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3427
3428 See also : "disabled"
3429
3430
3431errorfile <code> <file>
3432 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3434 yes | yes | yes | yes
3435 Arguments :
3436 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003437 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3438 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003439
3440 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003441 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003442 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003443 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3444 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003445
3446 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3447 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3448 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3449
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003450 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3453 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3454 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3455 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3456
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003457 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3458 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003459 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003460 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3461 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3462 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003464 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3465 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3466 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003467 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003468 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3469
3470 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3471
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003472 Example :
3473 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003474 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003475 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3476 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3477
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003478
3479errorloc <code> <url>
3480errorloc302 <code> <url>
3481 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3483 yes | yes | yes | yes
3484 Arguments :
3485 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003486 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3487 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003488
3489 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3490 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3491 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3492 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003493 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003494
3495 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3496 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3497 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3498
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003499 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3500
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003501 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3502 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3503 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3504 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003505 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003506 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3507 request.
3508
3509 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3510
3511
3512errorloc303 <code> <url>
3513 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3515 yes | yes | yes | yes
3516 Arguments :
3517 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003518 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3519 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003520
3521 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3522 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3523 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3524 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003525 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003526
3527 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3528 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3529 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3530
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003531 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3532
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003533 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3534 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3535 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3536 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003537 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003538
3539 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3540
3541
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003542email-alert from <emailaddr>
3543 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003544 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3546 yes | yes | yes | yes
3547
3548 Arguments :
3549
3550 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3551
3552 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3553 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3554
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003555 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003556 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3557 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003558
3559
3560email-alert level <level>
3561 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3562 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3563 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3564 yes | yes | yes | yes
3565
3566 Arguments :
3567
3568 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3569 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3570 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3571
3572 By default level is alert
3573
3574 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3575 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3576 for the proxy.
3577
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003578 Alerts are sent when :
3579
3580 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3581 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3582 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3583 is notice or lower
3584 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3585 and a health check status update occurs
3586
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003587 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3588 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003589 section 3.6 about mailers.
3590
3591
3592email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3593 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3594 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3595 yes | yes | yes | yes
3596
3597 Arguments :
3598
3599 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3600
3601 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3602 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3603
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003604 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3605 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003606
3607
3608email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3609 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3610 mailers.
3611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3612 yes | yes | yes | yes
3613
3614 Arguments :
3615
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003616 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003617
3618 By default the systems hostname is used.
3619
3620 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3621 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3622 for the proxy.
3623
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003624 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3625 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003626
3627
3628email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003629 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003630 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3631 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | yes
3633
3634 Arguments :
3635
3636 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3637
3638 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3639 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3640
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003641 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003642 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3643
3644
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003645force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3646 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3647 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003648 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003649
3650 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3651 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3652 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3653 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3654 marked down for maintenance operations.
3655
3656 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3657 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3658 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3659 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3660 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3661 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3662 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3663 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3664 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3665
3666 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3667 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3668 is used.
3669
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003670 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003671 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003672
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003673
3674filter <name> [param*]
3675 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3676 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3677 no | yes | yes | yes
3678 Arguments :
3679 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3680 referenced in section 9.
3681
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003682 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003683 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003684 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3685 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003686
3687 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3688 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3689
3690 Example:
3691 listen
3692 bind *:80
3693
3694 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3695 filter compression
3696 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3697
3698 compression algo gzip
3699 compression offload
3700
3701 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3702
3703 See also : section 9.
3704
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003705
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003706fullconn <conns>
3707 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3709 yes | no | yes | yes
3710 Arguments :
3711 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3712 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3713
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003714 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003715 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003716 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003717 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3718 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3719 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3720 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3721 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003722 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003723
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003724 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3725 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003726 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3727 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3728 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003729
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003730 Example :
3731 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3732 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3733 # connections.
3734 backend dynamic
3735 fullconn 10000
3736 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3737 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3738
3739 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3740
3741
3742grace <time>
3743 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003745 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003746 Arguments :
3747 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3748 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3749 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3750
3751 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3752 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003753 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003754 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3755
3756 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3757 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3758 simplify it.
3759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003760
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003761hash-balance-factor <factor>
3762 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | no | no | yes
3765 Arguments :
3766 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3767 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003768 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003769
3770 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3771 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3772 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3773 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3774 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3775 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3776 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3777
3778 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3779 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3780 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3781 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3782 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3783
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003784 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3785 consistent hashing mechanism.
3786
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003787 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3788
3789
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003790hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003791 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3793 yes | no | yes | yes
3794 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003795 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3796 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003797
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003798 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3799 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3800 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3801 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3802 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3803 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3804 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3805 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3806 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3807 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003808
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003809 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3810 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3811 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3812 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3813 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3814 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3815 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3816 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3817 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3818 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3819 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3820 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3821 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003822 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3823 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003824
3825 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3826
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003827 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003828 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3829 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3830 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003831 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3832 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3833 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003834
3835 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3836 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003837 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3838 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3839 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3840 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3841
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003842 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3843 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3844 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3845 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3846 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3847 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3848 parameter.
3849
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003850 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3851 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3852 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3853 used on strings.
3854
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003855 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3856
3857 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3858 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3859 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3860 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3861 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3862 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3863 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3864 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3865 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3866 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3867 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3868 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003869
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003870 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3871 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3872 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003873
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003874 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003875
3876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877http-check disable-on-404
3878 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003880 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003881 Arguments : none
3882
3883 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3884 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3885 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3886 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3887 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3888 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3889 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3890 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003891 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3892 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3893 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3894
3895 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3896
3897
3898http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003899 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003901 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003902 Arguments :
3903 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3904 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003905 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003906 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3907 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3908 details on the supported keywords.
3909
3910 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3911 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3912 with the usual backslash ('\').
3913
3914 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3915 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3916 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3917 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3918 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3919
3920 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003921 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003922 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3923 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3924 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3925
3926 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003927 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003928 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3929 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3930 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3931 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3932
3933 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003934 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003935 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3936 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3937 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3938 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3939 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003940 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003941 trace).
3942
3943 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003944 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003945 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3946 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3947 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3948 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3949 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003950 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003951
3952 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3953 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3954 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3955 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3956 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3957 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3958 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3959 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3960
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003961 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3962 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3963 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3964
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003965 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3966 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3967
3968 Examples :
3969 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003970 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003971
3972 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003973 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003974
3975 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003976 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003977
3978 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003979 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003980
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003981 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003982
3983
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003984http-check send-state
3985 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3987 yes | no | yes | yes
3988 Arguments : none
3989
3990 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3991 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3992 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3993 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3994 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3995
3996 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3997 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3998 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3999 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4000 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004001 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4002 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4003 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4004
4005 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4006 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4007 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4008
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004009 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4010 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4011 checked in multiple backends.
4012
4013 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4014 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4015
4016 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4017 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4018 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4019 one fails.
4020
4021 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4022 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4023 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4024
4025 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4026 server's queue.
4027
4028 Example of a header received by the application server :
4029 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4030 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4031
4032 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004034
4035http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004036 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4037
4038 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4039 no | yes | yes | yes
4040
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004041 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4042 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4043 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4044 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4045 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004046
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004047 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4048 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004050 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004051
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004052 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4053 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4054 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4055 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004057 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4058 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4059 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4060 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004062 Example:
4063 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4064 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4065 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004067 http-request allow if nagios
4068 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4069 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4070 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004072 Example:
4073 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4074 acl add path /addacl
4075 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004077 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004079 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4080 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004082 Example:
4083 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4084 acl setmap path /setmap
4085 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004087 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004089 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4090 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004092 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4093 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004095http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004097 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4098 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4099 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4100 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4101 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4102 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4103 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4104 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004106http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004108 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4109 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4110 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4111 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4112 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4113 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4114 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4115 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004117http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004119 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4120 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004121
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004123http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004125 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4126 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4127 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4128 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4129 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004131 Example:
4132 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4133 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004134
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004135http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004137 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004139http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4140 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004142 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4143 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4144 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4145 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4146 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4147 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4148 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4149 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4150 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004152 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4153 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4154 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4155 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4156 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4157 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004159http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004160
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004161 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4162 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4163 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4164 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4165 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4166 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004170 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004172http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4175 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4176 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4177 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4178 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4179 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004181http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004183 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4184 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4185 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4186 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4187 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004188
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004189http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4190
4191 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4192 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4193 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4194 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004195 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4196 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004197
4198 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4199
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004200http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004201
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004202 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4203 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4204 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4205 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4206 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004208http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004210 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4211 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4212 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4213 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004215http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4216 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4219 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4220 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4221 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4222 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4223 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4224 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4225 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004226
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004227 Example:
4228 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004230 # applied to:
4231 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004232
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004233 # outputs:
4234 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004237
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004238http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4239 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4242 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4243 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4244 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246 Example:
4247 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004248
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004249 # applied to:
4250 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252 # outputs:
4253 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004255http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4256http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004258 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4259 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4260 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004261
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004262http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4265 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4266 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004267
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004268http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4271 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4272 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4273 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4274 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004275
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004276 Arguments:
4277 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4278 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004280 Example:
4281 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4282 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004284 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4285 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004287http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4290 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4291 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004293 Arguments:
4294 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4295 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004296
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004297 Example:
4298 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4299 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4302 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4303 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4308 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4309 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4310 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4311 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 Example:
4314 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4315 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4316 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4317 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4318 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4319 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4320 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4321 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4322 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4327 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4328 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4329 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4330 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004331
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004332http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4333 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004334
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004335 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4336 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4337 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4338 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4339 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4340 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4341 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4342 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4343 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004344
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004345http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004346
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004347 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4348 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4349 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4350 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4351 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4352 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4353 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004355http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004356
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004357 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4358 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4359 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4364 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4365 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4366 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4367 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4368 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4369 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4370 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004373
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004374 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4375 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4376 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4377 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4378 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4379 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004381 Example :
4382 # prepend the host name before the path
4383 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004385http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004387 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4388 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4389 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4390 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4391 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004393http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004394
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004395 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4396 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4397 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4398 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4399 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4400 values have higher priority.
4401 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4402 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4403 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4404 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4405 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004407http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4410 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4411 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4412 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4413 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4414 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4415 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004417 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004418
4419 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004420 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4421 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004423http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4424 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4425 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4426 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4427 privacy.
4428
4429 Arguments :
4430 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4431 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004432
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004433 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004434 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4435 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4436
4437 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4438 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4439
4440http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4441
4442 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4443 expression.
4444
4445 Arguments:
4446 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4447 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004448
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004449 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004450 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4451 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4452
4453 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4454 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4455 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4456
4457http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4458
4459 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4460 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4461 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4462 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4463 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4464 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4465 information from the request.
4466
4467 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4468
4469http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4470
4471 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4472 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4473 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4474 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4475 path and the query string.
4476 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4477
4478http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4479
4480 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4481 inline.
4482
4483 Arguments:
4484 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4485 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4486 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4487 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4488 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4489 (request and response)
4490 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4491 processing
4492 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4493 processing
4494 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4495 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4496 and '_'.
4497
4498 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4499 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004500
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004501 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004502 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4505 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4508 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4509 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4510 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4511 agent name must be used.
4512
4513 Arguments:
4514 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4515
4516 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4517 configuration.
4518
4519http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4520
4521 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4522 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4523 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4524 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4525 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4526 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4527 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4528 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4529 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4530 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4531 action.
4532 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4533 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4534 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4535 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4536 you fully understand how it works.
4537
4538http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4539
4540 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4541 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4542 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4543 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4544 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4545 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4546 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4547 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4548 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4549 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4550 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4551 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4552 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4553
4554http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4555http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4556http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4557
4558 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4559 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4560 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4561 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4562 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4563 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4564 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4565 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4566 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4567 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4568 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4569 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4570
4571 Arguments :
4572 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4573 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4574 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4575 select which table entry to update the counters.
4576
4577 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4578 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4579 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4580 that table until the session ends.
4581
4582 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4583 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4584 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4585 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4586 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4587 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4588 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4589 useful information.
4590
4591 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4592 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4593 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4594 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4595 checks that make use of it.
4596
4597http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4598
4599 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004600
4601 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004603
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004604http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004606 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4607 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4608 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004609
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004610
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004611http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004612 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4613
4614 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4615 no | yes | yes | yes
4616
4617 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4618 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4619 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4620 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4621 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4622 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4623
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004624 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4625 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004626
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004627 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004629 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4630 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4631 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4632 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004633
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004634 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4635 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4636 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4637 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004638
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004639 Example:
4640 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004641
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004642 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004643
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004644 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4645 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004646
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004647 Example:
4648 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004649
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004650 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004652 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4653 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004655 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4656 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004657
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004658http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004659
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004660 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4661 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4662 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4663 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4664 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4665 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4666 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4667 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004668
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004669http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004670
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004671 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4672 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4673 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4674 example, or to pass some internal information.
4675 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4676 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4677 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004678
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004679http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004681 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4682 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004683
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004684http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004685
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004686 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004687
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004688http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004689
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004690 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4691 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4692 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4693 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4694 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4695 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4696 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004697
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004698 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4699 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4700 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4701 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4702 keyword.
4703 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4704 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004706http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004708 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4709 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4710 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4711 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4712 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4713 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004715http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004717 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004718
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004719http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004720
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004721 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4722 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4723 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4724 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4725 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4726 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004728http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004730 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4731 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004732
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004733http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004734
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004735 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4736 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4737 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4738 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4739 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4740 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004742http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4743 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004745 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4746 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4747 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4748 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4749 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4750 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4751 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4752 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004754 Example:
4755 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004757 # applied to:
4758 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004759
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004760 # outputs:
4761 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004762
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004763 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004765http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4766 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004768 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4769 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4770 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4771 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004773 Example:
4774 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004776 # applied to:
4777 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004779 # outputs:
4780 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004781
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004782http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4783http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004784
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004785 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4786 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4787 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004789http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4792 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4793 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004794
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004795http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004797 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4798 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4799 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4800 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4801 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004802
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004803 Arguments:
4804 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004806 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4807 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004808
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004809http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004810
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004811 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4812 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4813 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004814
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004815http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4816
4817 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4818 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4819 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4820 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4821 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4822
4823http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4824
4825 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4826 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4827 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4828 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4829 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4830 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4831 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4832 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4833 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4834
4835http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4836
4837 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4838 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4839 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4840 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4841 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4842 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4843 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4844
4845http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4846
4847 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4848 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4849 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4850 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4851 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4852 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4853 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4854 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4855
4856http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4857 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4858
4859 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4860 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4861 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4862 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004863
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004864 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004865 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4866 http-response set-status 431
4867 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4868 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004870http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004872 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4873 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4874 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4875 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4876 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4877 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4878 based on some information from the request.
4879
4880 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4881
4882http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4883
4884 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4885 inline.
4886
4887 Arguments:
4888 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4889 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4890 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4891 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4892 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4893 (request and response)
4894 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4895 processing
4896 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4897 processing
4898 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4899 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4900 and '_'.
4901
4902 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4903 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004904
4905 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004906 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004908http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4911 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4912 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4913 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4914 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4915 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4916 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4917 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4918 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4919 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4920 action.
4921 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4922 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4923 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4924 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4925 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004927http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4928http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4929http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004930
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004931 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4932 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4933 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4934 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4935 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4936 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4937
4938http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4939
4940 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4941 about <var-name>.
4942
4943 Example:
4944 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4945
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004946
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004947http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4948 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4949
4950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | no | yes | yes
4952
4953 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004954 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
4955 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
4956 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004957
4958 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4959
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004960 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
4961 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
4962 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
4963 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
4964 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
4965 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
4966 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
4967 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
4968 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
4969 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004970
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004971 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
4972 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
4973 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
4974 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
4975 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
4976 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
4977 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
4978 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004979
4980 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4981 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4982 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4983 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4984 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4985 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4986 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4987 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4988 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4989 downsides of rare connection failures.
4990
4991 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4992 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4993 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4994 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4995 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4996 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004997 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004998 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4999 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5000 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5001 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5002 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5003
5004 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005005 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5006 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5007 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005008
5009 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005010 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005011
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005012 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5013 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005014
5015 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5016 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5017 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5018
5019 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5020 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5021 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5022
5023 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5024
5025
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005026http-send-name-header [<header>]
5027 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5028
5029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5030 yes | no | yes | yes
5031
5032 Arguments :
5033
5034 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5035
5036 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005037 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005038 is added with the header string proved.
5039
5040 See also : "server"
5041
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005042id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005043 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5045 no | yes | yes | yes
5046 Arguments : none
5047
5048 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5049 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5050 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005051
5052
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005053ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5054 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5055 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005056 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005057
5058 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5059 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5060 and running).
5061
5062 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5063 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5064 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005065 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005066 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5067
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005068 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5069 "unless" condition is met.
5070
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005071 Example:
5072 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5073 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5074 ignore-persist if url_static
5075
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005076 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5077
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005078load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5079 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5081 yes | no | yes | yes
5082
5083 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5084 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5085 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005086 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005087 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5088 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5089 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5090 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5091
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005092 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005093 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005094 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005095
5096 Arguments:
5097 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5098 named "server-state-file".
5099
5100 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5101 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5102 name is used as a file name.
5103
5104 none don't load any stat for this backend
5105
5106 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005107 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5108 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5109 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005110 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005111 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005112
5113 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5114 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5115
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005116 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005117
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005118 global
5119 stats socket /tmp/socket
5120 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005121
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005122 defaults
5123 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005124
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005125 backend bk
5126 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5127 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005128
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005129
5130 Then one can run :
5131
5132 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5133
5134 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5135
5136 1
5137 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5138 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5139 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5140
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005141 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005142
5143 global
5144 stats socket /tmp/socket
5145 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5146
5147 defaults
5148 load-server-state-from-file local
5149
5150 backend bk
5151 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5152 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5153
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005154
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005155 Then one can run :
5156
5157 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5158
5159 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5160
5161 1
5162 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5163 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5164 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5165
5166 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5167 "show servers state"
5168
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005169
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005170log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005171log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005172no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005173 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5175 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005176
5177 Prefix :
5178 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5179 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5180 prefix does not allow arguments.
5181
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005182 Arguments :
5183 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5184 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5185 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5186 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5187 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5188 parameter.
5189
5190 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5191 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5192
5193 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5194 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5195 standard syslog port).
5196
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005197 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5198 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5199 standard syslog port).
5200
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005201 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5202 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5203 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005204 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005205
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005206 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5207 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5208 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5209 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5210 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5211 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5212 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5213 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5214 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5215 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5216 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5217 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5218 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5219 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5220 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5221 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005222 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5223 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005224
5225 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5226 and "fd@2", see above.
5227
5228 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5229 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005230
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005231 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5232 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5233 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5234 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5235 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5236 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5237 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5238 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5239 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5240 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005241 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005242
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005243 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5244 one of the following :
5245
5246 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5247 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5248
5249 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5250 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5251
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005252 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5253 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5254 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5255 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5256 systemd logger consumes.
5257
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005258 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5259 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5260 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5261 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5262
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005263 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5264
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005265 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5266 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5267 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5268
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005269 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5270 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5271 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5272 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005273
5274 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5275 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5276 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005277 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5278 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5279 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5280 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5281 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005282
5283 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5284
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005285 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5286 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5287 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005288
5289 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5290 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5291 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5292 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5293
5294 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5295 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005296
5297 Example :
5298 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005299 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5300 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5301 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005302 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5303 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005304 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005305
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005306
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005307log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005308 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5310 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005311
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005312 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5313 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5314 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5315 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5316 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005317
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005318 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5319 "option httplog" directives.
5320
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005321log-format-sd <string>
5322 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5324 yes | yes | yes | no
5325
5326 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5327 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5328 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5329 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5330 which covers the log format string in depth.
5331
5332 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5333 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5334
5335 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5336 log format to "rfc5424".
5337
5338 Example :
5339 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5340
5341
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005342log-tag <string>
5343 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5344 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5345 yes | yes | yes | yes
5346
5347 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5348 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5349 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5350 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5351 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5352 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5353 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5354 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5355 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005356
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005357max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5358 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5360 yes | no | yes | yes
5361
5362 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5363 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5364 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5365 servers.
5366
5367 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5368 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5369 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5370 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5371 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005372 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005373 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5374 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5375 picking a different server.
5376
5377 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5378 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5379 even if they have to be queued.
5380
5381 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5382 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5383
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005384max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5385 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5386 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5387 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005388
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005389maxconn <conns>
5390 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5392 yes | yes | yes | no
5393 Arguments :
5394 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5395 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5396 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5397 closes.
5398
5399 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5400 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5401 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5402 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005403 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5404 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5405 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5406 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005407
5408 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5409 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5410 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5411
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005412 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5413 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005414
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005415 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5416
5417
5418mode { tcp|http|health }
5419 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5421 yes | yes | yes | yes
5422 Arguments :
5423 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5424 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5425 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5426 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5427
5428 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5429 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5430 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5431 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5432 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5433
5434 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005435 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5436 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5437 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5438 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5439 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5440 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5441 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005442
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005443 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5444 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5445 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005446
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005447 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005448 defaults http_instances
5449 mode http
5450
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005451 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005452
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005453
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005454monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005455 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005458 Arguments :
5459 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5460 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005461 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005462 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5463 backend and its backup.
5464
5465 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5466 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5467 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5468 servers in a list of backends.
5469
5470 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5471 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5472 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5473 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5474 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5475 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5476 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005477 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5478 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005479
5480 Example:
5481 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005482 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005483 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5484 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5485 monitor-uri /site_alive
5486 monitor fail if site_dead
5487
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005488 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005489
5490
5491monitor-net <source>
5492 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | yes | yes | no
5495 Arguments :
5496 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5497 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5498 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5499 followed by a mask.
5500
5501 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5502 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005503 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005504 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5505
5506 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5507 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5508 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5509 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005510 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5511 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5512 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005514 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5515 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5516 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5517 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5518 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5519 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005520
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005521 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5522 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005523
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005524 Example :
5525 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5526 frontend www
5527 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5528
5529 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5530
5531
5532monitor-uri <uri>
5533 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5535 yes | yes | yes | no
5536 Arguments :
5537 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5538 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5539
5540 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5541 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5542 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5543 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5544 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5545 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5546 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5547 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5548
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005549 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5550 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5551 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5552 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5553 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5554 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5555 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5556 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005557
5558 Example :
5559 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5560 frontend www
5561 mode http
5562 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5563
5564 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5565
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005566
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005567option abortonclose
5568no option abortonclose
5569 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | no | yes | yes
5572 Arguments : none
5573
5574 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5575 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5576 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5577 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005578 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005579 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5580 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5581 encountered while delivering the response.
5582
5583 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5584 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5585 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5586 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5587 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5588 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005589 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005590 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005591 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005592 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5593 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5594 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5595
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005596 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5597 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005598 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5599 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5600 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5601 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5602 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5603 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005604 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005605
5606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5608
5609 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5610
5611
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005612option accept-invalid-http-request
5613no option accept-invalid-http-request
5614 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5616 yes | yes | yes | no
5617 Arguments : none
5618
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005619 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005620 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005621 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005622 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5623 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5624 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5625 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5626 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005627 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5628 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5629 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5630 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005631 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005632 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005633 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5634 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5635 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005636
5637 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5638 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5639 been confirmed.
5640
5641 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5642 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005643 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5644 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005645 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5646
5647 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5648 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5649
5650 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5651 stats socket.
5652
5653
5654option accept-invalid-http-response
5655no option accept-invalid-http-response
5656 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5658 yes | no | yes | yes
5659 Arguments : none
5660
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005661 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005662 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005663 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005664 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5665 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5666 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5667 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5668 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005669 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5670 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5671 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005672
5673 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5674 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5675 been confirmed.
5676
5677 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5678 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5679 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5680 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5681
5682 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5683 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5684
5685 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5686 stats socket.
5687
5688
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005689option allbackups
5690no option allbackups
5691 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5693 yes | no | yes | yes
5694 Arguments : none
5695
5696 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5697 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5698 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5699 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5700 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5701 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5702 order between the backup servers anymore.
5703
5704 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5705 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5706
5707 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5708 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5709
5710
5711option checkcache
5712no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005713 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5715 yes | no | yes | yes
5716 Arguments : none
5717
5718 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5719 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005720 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005721 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5722 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005723 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005724
5725 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005726 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005727 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005728 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5729 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005730 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005731 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005732 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5733 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005734 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005735 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5736 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005737 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005738 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5739 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5740 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5741 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5742 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5743 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5744 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5745 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5746 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5747
5748 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005749 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005750 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005751 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005752 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5753
5754 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5755 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005756 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005757 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005758
5759 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5760 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5761
5762
5763option clitcpka
5764no option clitcpka
5765 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5767 yes | yes | yes | no
5768 Arguments : none
5769
5770 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5771 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005772 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005773 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5774
5775 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5776 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5777 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5778 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5779
5780 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5781 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5782 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5783 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5784 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5785
5786 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5787
5788 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5789 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5790 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5791
5792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5794
5795 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5796
5797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005798option contstats
5799 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5801 yes | yes | yes | no
5802 Arguments : none
5803
5804 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5805 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5806 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5807 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005808 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5809 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5810 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5811 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5812 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005813
5814
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005815option dontlog-normal
5816no option dontlog-normal
5817 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5819 yes | yes | yes | no
5820 Arguments : none
5821
5822 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5823 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5824 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5825 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5826 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5827 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5828 logged.
5829
5830 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5831 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5832 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005834 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005835 logging.
5836
5837
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005838option dontlognull
5839no option dontlognull
5840 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5842 yes | yes | yes | no
5843 Arguments : none
5844
5845 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5846 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5847 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5848 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5849 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5850 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005851 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5852 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5853 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005854
5855 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005856 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005857 would not be logged.
5858
5859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5861
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005862 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5863 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005864
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005865
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005866option forceclose (deprecated)
5867no option forceclose (deprecated)
5868 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005869
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005870 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005871
5872
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005873option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005874 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5876 yes | yes | yes | yes
5877 Arguments :
5878 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5879 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005880 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005881 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005882
5883 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5884 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5885 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5886 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5887 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5888 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5889 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005890 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5891 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5892 possible that the client has already brought one.
5893
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005894 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005895 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005896 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005897 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005898 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005899 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005900
5901 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5902 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5903 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5904 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5905 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5906 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5907 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5908
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005909 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5910 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5911 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5912 are under the control of the end-user.
5913
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005914 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005915 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5916 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005917 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5918 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5919 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005920
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005921 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005922 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5923 frontend www
5924 mode http
5925 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5926
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005927 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5928 backend www
5929 mode http
5930 option forwardfor header X-Client
5931
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005932 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005933 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005934
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005935
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005936option http-buffer-request
5937no option http-buffer-request
5938 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5940 yes | yes | yes | yes
5941 Arguments : none
5942
5943 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5944 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5945 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5946 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5947 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5948 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5949 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5950 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005951 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005952 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5953 default.
5954
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005955 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005956
5957
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005958option http-ignore-probes
5959no option http-ignore-probes
5960 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5962 yes | yes | yes | no
5963 Arguments : none
5964
5965 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5966 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5967 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5968 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5969 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5970 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5971 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5972 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5973 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005974 was received over a connection before it was closed;
5975 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005976 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5977
5978 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5979 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5980 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5981 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5982 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5983 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5984 are often the only way to detect them.
5985
5986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5988
5989 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5990
5991
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005992option http-keep-alive
5993no option http-keep-alive
5994 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | yes | yes | yes
5997 Arguments : none
5998
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005999 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6000 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006001 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6002 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6003 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6004 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6005 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006006
6007 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6008 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006009 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6010 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6011 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6012 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6013 situations where this option may be useful :
6014
6015 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006016 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006017
6018 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6019 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6020
6021 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6022 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6023 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6024 request.
6025
6026 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6027 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006028 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6029 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6030 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006031
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006032 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6033 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6034 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6035 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6036 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6037 not set.
6038
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006039 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006040 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6041 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006042
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006043 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006044 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006045 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006046
6047
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006048option http-no-delay
6049no option http-no-delay
6050 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6052 yes | yes | yes | yes
6053 Arguments : none
6054
6055 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6056 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6057 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6058 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6059 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6060 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6061 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6062 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6063 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6064 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6065 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6066 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6067 affected.
6068
6069 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6070 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6071 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6072 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6073 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6074 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6075 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6076 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6077 latency environments.
6078
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006079 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6080
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006081
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006082option http-pretend-keepalive
6083no option http-pretend-keepalive
6084 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006086 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006087 Arguments : none
6088
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006089 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006090 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6091 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6092 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6093 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6094 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6095 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6096 consider the response complete.
6097
6098 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6099 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6100 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6101 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006102 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006103 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6104
6105 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6106 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6107 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6108 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6109 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6110 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6111 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6112
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006113 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6114 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6115 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6116 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6117 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6118 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006119
6120 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6121 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6122
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006123 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006124 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006125
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006126
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006127option http-server-close
6128no option http-server-close
6129 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6131 yes | yes | yes | yes
6132 Arguments : none
6133
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006134 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6135 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6136 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6137 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006138 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6139 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6140 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6141 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6142 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6143 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6144 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6145 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6146 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6147 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6148 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006149
6150 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6151 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6152 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6153 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006154 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6155 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006156
6157 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6158 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006159 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6160 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6161 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006162
6163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6165
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006166 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6167 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006168
6169
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006170option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6171no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6172 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006174 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006175 Arguments : none
6176
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006177 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6178 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6179 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6180
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006181 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6182 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6183 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6184 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006185 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006186
6187 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006188 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006189 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6190 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6191 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6192 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6193 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6194 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6195 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006196
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006197 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6198 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6199 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6200 backend.
6201
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006202 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6203 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006205 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6206 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006207
6208
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006209option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006210no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006211 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6213 yes | yes | yes | no
6214 Arguments : none
6215
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006216 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006217 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6218 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6219 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6220 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6221 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6222 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6223
6224 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6225 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006226 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6227 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6228 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006229
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006230 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6231 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6232 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6233 front of an existing proxy.
6234
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006235 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6236
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006237 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006238
6239
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006240option http-use-htx
6241no option http-use-htx
6242 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6244 yes | yes | yes | yes
6245 Arguments : none
6246
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006247 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006248 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006249 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6250 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6251 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6252 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6253 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006254
6255 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6256 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6257 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6258 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006259 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6260 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6261 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6262 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006263
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006264 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6265 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6266 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6267 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6268 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006269
6270 See also : "mode http"
6271
6272
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006273option httpchk
6274option httpchk <uri>
6275option httpchk <method> <uri>
6276option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6277 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6279 yes | no | yes | yes
6280 Arguments :
6281 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6282 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6283 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6284 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6285 ones.
6286
6287 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6288 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6289 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6290
6291 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6292 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6293 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6294 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6295 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6296
6297 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6298 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6299 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6300 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6301 the lack of any response.
6302
6303 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6304
6305 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6306 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6307 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6308
6309 Examples :
6310 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6311 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6312 backend https_relay
6313 mode tcp
6314 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6315 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6316
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006317 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6318 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6319 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006320
6321
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006322option httpclose
6323no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006324 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6326 yes | yes | yes | yes
6327 Arguments : none
6328
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006329 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6330 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6331 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6332 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006333 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006334
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006335 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6336 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6337 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6338 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6339 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006340
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006341 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6342 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6343 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006344
6345 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6346 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006347 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006348 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6349 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6350 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006351
6352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6354
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006355 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006356
6357
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006358option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006359 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006361 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006362 Arguments :
6363 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6364 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6365 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006366 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006367 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006368
6369 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6370 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6371 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6372 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6373 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6374 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6375 ports.
6376
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006377 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6378 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006379
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006380 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006382 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006383
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006384
6385option http_proxy
6386no option http_proxy
6387 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6389 yes | yes | yes | yes
6390 Arguments : none
6391
6392 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6393 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6394 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6395 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6396 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6397
6398 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6399 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006400 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6401 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006402
6403 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6404 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6405
6406 Example :
6407 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6408 backend direct_forward
6409 option httpclose
6410 option http_proxy
6411
6412 See also : "option httpclose"
6413
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006414
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006415option independent-streams
6416no option independent-streams
6417 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6419 yes | yes | yes | yes
6420 Arguments : none
6421
6422 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6423 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6424 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6425 receive data or not.
6426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006427 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006428 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6429 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6430 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6431 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6432 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6433 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6434 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6435 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6436 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6437 socket buffers.
6438
6439 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6440 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6441 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6442 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6443 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6444
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006445 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006446 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6447 deprecated.
6448
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006449 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006450
6451
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006452option ldap-check
6453 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6455 yes | no | yes | yes
6456 Arguments : none
6457
6458 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6459 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6460 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6461 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6462
6463 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6464 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6465
6466 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6467 configure it.
6468
6469 Example :
6470 option ldap-check
6471
6472 See also : "option httpchk"
6473
6474
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006475option external-check
6476 Use external processes for server health checks
6477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6478 yes | no | yes | yes
6479
6480 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6481 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6482 command".
6483
6484 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6485
6486 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6487
6488
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006489option log-health-checks
6490no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006491 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6493 yes | no | yes | yes
6494 Arguments : none
6495
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006496 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6497 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6498 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006499
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006500 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6501 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6502 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6503 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6504 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6505
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006506 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006507 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006508
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006509 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6510 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6511 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006512
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006513
6514option log-separate-errors
6515no option log-separate-errors
6516 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6518 yes | yes | yes | no
6519 Arguments : none
6520
6521 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6522 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6523 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6524 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6525 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6526 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6527 provides very important information.
6528
6529 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6530 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6531 error logs.
6532
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006533 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006534 logging.
6535
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006536
6537option logasap
6538no option logasap
6539 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6541 yes | yes | yes | no
6542 Arguments : none
6543
6544 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6545 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6546 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6547 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6548 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6549 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6550 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006551 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006552 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6553 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6554
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006555 Examples :
6556 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6557 mode http
6558 option httplog
6559 option logasap
6560 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6561
6562 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6563 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6564 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6565 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006567 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006568 logging.
6569
6570
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006571option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006572 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6574 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006575 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006576 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6577 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006578 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006579
6580 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6581 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006582 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006583 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6584 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6585 in the MySQL table, like this :
6586
6587 USE mysql;
6588 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6589 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6590
6591 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006592 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006593 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6594 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6595 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6596 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6597 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6598 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6599 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6600
6601 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6602 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006603
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006604 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006605
6606 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6607 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6608 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6609 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006610 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6611 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006612
6613 See also: "option httpchk"
6614
6615
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006616option nolinger
6617no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006618 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6620 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006621 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006622
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006623 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006624 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6625 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6626 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6627 connections.
6628
6629 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6630 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6631 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6632 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6633 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6634 this too.
6635
6636 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6637 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6638 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6639
6640 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6641 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6642 for servers.
6643
6644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6646
6647
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006648option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6649 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6651 yes | yes | yes | yes
6652 Arguments :
6653 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6654 matching <network>
6655 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6656 header name.
6657
6658 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6659 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6660 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6661 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6662 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6663 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6664 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6665 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6666 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6667 possible that the client has already brought one.
6668
6669 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6670 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6671 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6672 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6673 header and requires different one.
6674
6675 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6676 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6677 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6678 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6679 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6680 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6681 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6682
6683 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6684 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6685 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6686 both are defined.
6687
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006688 Examples :
6689 # Original Destination address
6690 frontend www
6691 mode http
6692 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6693
6694 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6695 backend www
6696 mode http
6697 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6698
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006699 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006700
6701
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006702option persist
6703no option persist
6704 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006707 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006708
6709 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6710 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6711 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6712 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6713 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6714 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6715 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6716 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6717 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6718 redirected to another valid server.
6719
6720 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6721 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6722
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006723 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006724
6725
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006726option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6727 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6729 yes | no | yes | yes
6730 Arguments :
6731 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6732 PostgreSQL server.
6733
6734 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6735 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6736 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6737 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6738
6739 See also: "option httpchk"
6740
6741
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006742option prefer-last-server
6743no option prefer-last-server
6744 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6745 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 yes | no | yes | yes
6747 Arguments : none
6748
6749 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6750 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6751 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6752 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6753 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6754 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6755 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6756 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6757 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006758 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6759 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006760 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6761 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6762 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006763 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6764 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6765 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006766
6767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6769
6770 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6771
6772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006773option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006774option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006775no option redispatch
6776 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006779 Arguments :
6780 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6781 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6782 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006783 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006784 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006785 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006786 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6787 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6788 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006790
6791 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6792 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6793 be able to access the service anymore.
6794
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006795 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6796 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006797
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006798 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006799 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6800 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006801
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006802 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6803 "redisp" keywords.
6804
6805 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6806 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6807
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006808 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006809
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006810
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006811option redis-check
6812 Use redis health checks for server testing
6813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6814 yes | no | yes | yes
6815 Arguments : none
6816
6817 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6818 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6819 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6820 find the "+PONG" response message.
6821
6822 Example :
6823 option redis-check
6824
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006825 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006826
6827
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006828option smtpchk
6829option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6830 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6832 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006833 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006834 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006835 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006836 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6837
6838 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6839 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6840 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6841
6842 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6843 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6844 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6845 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6846 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6847 dead server.
6848
6849 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6850 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006851 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006852 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6853
6854 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6855 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6856 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6857 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006858 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006859
6860 Example :
6861 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6862
6863 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6864
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006865
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006866option socket-stats
6867no option socket-stats
6868
6869 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6871 yes | yes | yes | no
6872
6873 Arguments : none
6874
6875
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006876option splice-auto
6877no option splice-auto
6878 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6880 yes | yes | yes | yes
6881 Arguments : none
6882
6883 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6884 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006885 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006886 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006887 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006888 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6889 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6890 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6891 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6892
6893 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6894 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6895 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6896 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6897 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6898 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6899 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6900 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6901 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6902 keyword.
6903
6904 Example :
6905 option splice-auto
6906
6907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6909
6910 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6911 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6912
6913
6914option splice-request
6915no option splice-request
6916 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6918 yes | yes | yes | yes
6919 Arguments : none
6920
6921 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006922 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006923 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6924 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6925 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6926 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6927
6928 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6929
6930 Example :
6931 option splice-request
6932
6933 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6934 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6935
6936 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6937 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6938
6939
6940option splice-response
6941no option splice-response
6942 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6944 yes | yes | yes | yes
6945 Arguments : none
6946
6947 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006948 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006949 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6950 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6951 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6952 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6953
6954 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6955
6956 Example :
6957 option splice-response
6958
6959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6961
6962 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6963 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6964
6965
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006966option spop-check
6967 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6969 no | no | no | yes
6970 Arguments : none
6971
6972 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6973 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6974 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6975 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6976
6977 Example :
6978 option spop-check
6979
6980 See also : "option httpchk"
6981
6982
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006983option srvtcpka
6984no option srvtcpka
6985 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6987 yes | no | yes | yes
6988 Arguments : none
6989
6990 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6991 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006992 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006993 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6994
6995 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6996 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6997 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6998 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6999
7000 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7001 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7002 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7003 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7004 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7005
7006 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7007
7008 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7009 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7010 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7011
7012 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7013 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7014
7015 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7016
7017
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007018option ssl-hello-chk
7019 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7021 yes | no | yes | yes
7022 Arguments : none
7023
7024 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7025 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7026 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7027 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7028 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7029 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7030 hello message.
7031
7032 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7033 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7034 messages, which is appreciable.
7035
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007036 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7037 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7038 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007039
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007040 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7041
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007042
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007043option tcp-check
7044 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7045 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7046 yes | no | yes | yes
7047
7048 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7049 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7050
7051 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7052 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7053 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7054
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007055 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007056 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7057 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7058 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7059 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7060 only.
7061
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007062 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007063 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7064 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7065 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7066 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7067
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007068 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007069 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7070 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007071 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007072 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7073 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7074 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7075 the respective protocols.
7076 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007077 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007078
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007079 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7080 script.
7081
7082 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7083 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7084 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7085 The "comment" is of course optional.
7086
7087
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007088 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007089 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007090 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007091 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007092
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007093 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007094 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007095 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007096
7097 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7098 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007099 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007100 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007101 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007102 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007103 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007104 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007105 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7106 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007107 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007108 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7109 tcp-check expect string +OK
7110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007111 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007112 (send many headers before analyzing)
7113 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007114 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007115 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7116 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7117 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7118 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007119 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007120
7121
7122 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7123
7124
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007125option tcp-smart-accept
7126no option tcp-smart-accept
7127 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7129 yes | yes | yes | no
7130 Arguments : none
7131
7132 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7133 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7134 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7135 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7136 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7137 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7138
7139 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7140 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7141 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7142 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7143
7144 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7145 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7146 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007147 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007148
7149 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7150 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7151 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7152
7153 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7154 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7155 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7156
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007157 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7158
7159
7160option tcp-smart-connect
7161no option tcp-smart-connect
7162 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7164 yes | no | yes | yes
7165 Arguments : none
7166
7167 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7168 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7169 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7170 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7171 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7172
7173 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7174 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7175 complex.
7176
7177 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7178 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7179 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7180
7181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7183
7184 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7185
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007186
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007187option tcpka
7188 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 yes | yes | yes | yes
7191 Arguments : none
7192
7193 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7194 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007195 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007196 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7197
7198 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7199 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7200 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7201 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7202
7203 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7204 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7205 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7206 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7207 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7208
7209 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7210
7211 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7212 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7213 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7214 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7215 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7216 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7217 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7218 backends.
7219
7220 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7221
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007222
7223option tcplog
7224 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007226 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007227 Arguments : none
7228
7229 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7230 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7231 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7232 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7233 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7234 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7235 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7236 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7237
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007238 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007240 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007241
7242
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007243option transparent
7244no option transparent
7245 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007247 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007248 Arguments : none
7249
7250 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7251 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7252 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7253 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7254 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7255 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7256 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7257 appropriate server.
7258
7259 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7260 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7261
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007262 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007263 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007264
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007265
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007266external-check command <command>
7267 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7269 yes | no | yes | yes
7270
7271 Arguments :
7272 <command> is the external command to run
7273
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007274 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7275
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007276 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007277
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007278 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7279 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7280 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7281 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7282 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7283 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007284
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007285 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7286
7287 Environment variables :
7288 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7289 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7290
7291 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7292
7293 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7294
7295 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7296 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7297 for a UNIX socket).
7298
7299 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7300
7301 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7302
7303 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7304
7305 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7306
7307 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7308
7309 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7310 socket).
7311
7312 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7313 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7314
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007315 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7316 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7317 failed.
7318
7319 Example :
7320 external-check command /bin/true
7321
7322 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7323
7324
7325external-check path <path>
7326 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7328 yes | no | yes | yes
7329
7330 Arguments :
7331 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7332
7333 The default path is "".
7334
7335 Example :
7336 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7337
7338 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7339 "external-check command"
7340
7341
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007342persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007343persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007344 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7346 yes | no | yes | yes
7347 Arguments :
7348 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007349 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7350 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007351
7352 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7353 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007354 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007355 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7356 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7357 forwarded to this server.
7358
7359 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7360 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7361 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007362 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007363 a single "listen" section.
7364
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007365 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7366 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7367 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7368
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007369 Example :
7370 listen tse-farm
7371 bind :3389
7372 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7373 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7374 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7375 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7376 persist rdp-cookie
7377 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007378 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007379 balance rdp-cookie
7380 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7381 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7382
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007383 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7384 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007385
7386
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007387rate-limit sessions <rate>
7388 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7390 yes | yes | yes | no
7391 Arguments :
7392 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7393 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7394
7395 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7396 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7397 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7398 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7399 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7400 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7401
7402 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7403 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7404 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7405 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7406
7407 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7408 listen smtp
7409 mode tcp
7410 bind :25
7411 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007412 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007413
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007414 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7415 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7416 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007417
7418 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7419
7420
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007421redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7422redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7423redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007424 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7426 no | yes | yes | yes
7427
7428 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007429 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007430
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007431 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007432 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007433 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7434 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7435 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007436
7437 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7438 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7439 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7440 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7441 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007442 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7443 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7444 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7445 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007446
7447 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7448 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7449 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7450 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7451 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7452 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007453 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007454 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007455 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7456 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7457 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007458
7459 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007460 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7461 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7462 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007463 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007464 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7465 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7466 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7467 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007468
7469 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007470 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007471
7472 - "drop-query"
7473 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7474 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7475 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7476 with a location-type redirect.
7477
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007478 - "append-slash"
7479 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7480 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7481 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7482 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7483
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007484 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7485 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7486 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7487 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7488 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7489 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7490 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7491
7492 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7493 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7494 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7495 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7496 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7497 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7498 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007499
7500 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7501 acl clear dst_port 80
7502 acl secure dst_port 8080
7503 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007504 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007505 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007506 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7507
7508 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007509 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7510 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7511 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007512 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007513
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007514 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7515 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7516 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7517
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007518 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007519 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007520
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007521 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007522 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7523 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7524 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007526 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007527
7528
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007529redisp (deprecated)
7530redispatch (deprecated)
7531 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7532 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7533 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007534 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007535
7536 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7537 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7538 be able to access the service anymore.
7539
7540 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7541 redistribute them to a working server.
7542
7543 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7544 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7545 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007546
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007547 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7548 "option redispatch" instead.
7549
7550 See also : "option redispatch"
7551
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007552
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007553reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007554 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7555 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7556 no | yes | yes | yes
7557 Arguments :
7558 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7559 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007560 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007561
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007562 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7563 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7564
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007565 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7566 the last header of an HTTP request.
7567
7568 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7569 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7570 responses.
7571
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007572 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7573 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7574 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7575
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007576 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7577 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007578
7579
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007580reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7581reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007582 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7583 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7584 no | yes | yes | yes
7585 Arguments :
7586 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7587 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7588 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7589 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7590 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7591 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7592 ignores case.
7593
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007594 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7595 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7596
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007597 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7598 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7599 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7600 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007601 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007602
7603 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7604 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7605
7606 Example :
7607 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7608 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7609 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7610
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007611 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7612 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007613
7614
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007615reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7616reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007617 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7619 no | yes | yes | yes
7620 Arguments :
7621 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7622 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7623 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7624 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7625 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7626 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7627
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007628 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7629 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7630
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007631 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7632 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7633 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7634 next servers.
7635
7636 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7637 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7638 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7639
7640 Example :
7641 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7642 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7643 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7644
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007645 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7646 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007647
7648
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007649reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7650reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007651 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7653 no | yes | yes | yes
7654 Arguments :
7655 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7656 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7657 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7658 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7659 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7660 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7661 case.
7662
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007663 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7664 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7665
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007666 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7667 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7668 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7669 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007670 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007671
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007672 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007673 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007674 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007675
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007676 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7677 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7678
7679 Example :
7680 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7681 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7682 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7683
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007684 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7685 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007686
7687
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007688reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7689reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007690 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7692 no | yes | yes | yes
7693 Arguments :
7694 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7695 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7696 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7697 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7698 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7699 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7700 case.
7701
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007702 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7703 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7704
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007705 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7706 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7707 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7708 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7709
7710 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7711 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7712
7713 Example :
7714 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7715 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7716 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7717 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7718
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007719 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7720 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007721
7722
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007723reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7724reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007725 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7727 no | yes | yes | yes
7728 Arguments :
7729 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7730 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7731 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7732 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7733 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7734 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7735
7736 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7737 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7738 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7739 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007740 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007741
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007742 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7743 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7744
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007745 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7746 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7747 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7748
7749 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7750 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7751 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7752 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7753 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7754
7755 Example :
7756 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007757 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007758 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7759 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7760
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007761 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7762 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007763
7764
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007765reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7766reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007767 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7769 no | yes | yes | yes
7770 Arguments :
7771 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7772 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7773 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7774 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7775 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7776 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7777 ignores case.
7778
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007779 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7780 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7781
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007782 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7783 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007784 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7785 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7786 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007787 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7788 not set.
7789
7790 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7791 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7792 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7793 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7794 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7795
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007796 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007797 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007798 # block all others.
7799 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7800 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7801
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007802 # block bad guys
7803 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7804 reqitarpit . if badguys
7805
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007806 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7807 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007808
7809
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007810retries <value>
7811 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7813 yes | no | yes | yes
7814 Arguments :
7815 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7816 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7817 default value is 3.
7818
7819 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7820 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7821 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7822
7823 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007824 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7825 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007826
7827 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7828 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7829
7830 See also : "option redispatch"
7831
7832
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007833rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007834 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7836 no | yes | yes | yes
7837 Arguments :
7838 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7839 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007840 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007841
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007842 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7843 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7844
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007845 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7846 the last header of an HTTP response.
7847
7848 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7849 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7850 responses.
7851
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007852 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7853 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007854
7855
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007856rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7857rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007858 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7860 no | yes | yes | yes
7861 Arguments :
7862 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7863 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7864 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7865 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7866 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7867 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7868 ignores case.
7869
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007870 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7871 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7872
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007873 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7874 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007875 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007876 client.
7877
7878 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7879 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7880 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7881
7882 Example :
7883 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007884 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007885
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007886 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7887 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007888
7889
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007890rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7891rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007892 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7893 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7894 no | yes | yes | yes
7895 Arguments :
7896 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7897 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7898 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7899 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7900 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7901 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7902 ignores case.
7903
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007904 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7905 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7906
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007907 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7908 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7909 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7910 case-sensitive.
7911
7912 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007913 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7914 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7915 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007916
7917 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7918 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7919
7920 Example :
7921 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7922 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7923
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007924 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7925 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007926
7927
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007928rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7929rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007930 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 no | yes | yes | yes
7933 Arguments :
7934 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7935 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7936 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7937 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7938 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7939 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7940 ignores case.
7941
7942 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7943 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7944 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7945 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007946 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007947
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007948 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7949 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7950
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007951 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7952 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7953 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7954
7955 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7956 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7957 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7958 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7959 are not case-sensitive.
7960
7961 Example :
7962 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7963 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7964
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007965 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7966 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007967
7968
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007969server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007970 Declare a server in a backend
7971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7972 no | no | yes | yes
7973 Arguments :
7974 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007975 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007976 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007977
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007978 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7979 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7980 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7981 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007982 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7983 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7984 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7985 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7986 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007987 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7988 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7989 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7990 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7991 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7992 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7993 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007994 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02007995 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
7996 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
7997 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
7998 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
7999 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8000 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008001 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8002 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008003 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8004 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008005
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008006 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008007 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8008 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8009 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8010 adding this value to the client's port.
8011
8012 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8013 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008014 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008015
8016 Examples :
8017 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8018 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008019 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008020 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8021 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8022 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008023
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008024 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8025 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8026 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8027 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8028 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8029
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008030 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8031 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008032
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008033server-state-file-name [<file>]
8034 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8035 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8036 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8037 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8038 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8039 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8040
8041 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8042 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8043
8044 global
8045 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8046
8047 backend bk
8048 load-server-state-from-file
8049
8050 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8051 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008052
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008053server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8054 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8055 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8057 no | no | yes | yes
8058
8059 Arguments:
8060 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8061
8062 <num | range>
8063 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8064 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8065 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8066 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8067
8068 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8069
8070 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8071
8072 <params*>
8073 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8074 keyword.
8075
8076 Examples:
8077 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8078 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8079 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8080
8081 # or
8082 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8083
8084 # would be equivalent to:
8085 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8086 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8087 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8088
8089
8090
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008091source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008092source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008093source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008094 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8096 yes | no | yes | yes
8097 Arguments :
8098 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8099 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008100
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008101 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008102 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8103 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8104 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8105 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8106 supported prefixes are :
8107 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8108 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8109 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008110 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008111 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8112 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008113
8114 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8115 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008116 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8117 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8118 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008119
8120 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8121 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8122 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8123 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8124 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8125 <addr>.
8126
8127 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8128 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8129 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8130 port.
8131
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008132 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8133 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8134 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8135 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008136 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008137 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8138 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8139 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8140 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8141 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8142 HTTP header.
8143
8144 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8145 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008146 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008147 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8148 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8149 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8150 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8151 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8152 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8153 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8154
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008155 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8156 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8157 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8158 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8159 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8160 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8161
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008162 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8163 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8164 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8165 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8166
8167 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8168 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8169 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8170 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8171 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8172 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8173
8174 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8175 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8176 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8177 there are two methods :
8178
8179 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8180 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8181 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8182 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8183 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8184 of the client ranges may be used.
8185
8186 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8187 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8188 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8189 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8190 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8191 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8192 same session.
8193
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008194 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8195 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8196 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008197 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008198
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008199 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8200
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008201 Examples :
8202 backend private
8203 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8204 source 192.168.1.200
8205
8206 backend transparent_ssl1
8207 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8208 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8209
8210 backend transparent_ssl2
8211 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8212 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8213 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8214
8215 backend transparent_ssl3
8216 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8217 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8218 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8219
8220 backend transparent_smtp
8221 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8222 # with Tproxy version 4.
8223 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8224
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008225 backend transparent_http
8226 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8227 # proxy.
8228 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008230 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008231 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008233
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008234srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8235 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8237 yes | no | yes | yes
8238 Arguments :
8239 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8240 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8241 as explained at the top of this document.
8242
8243 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8244 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8245 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8246 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8247 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8248 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8249 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8250
8251 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8252 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8253 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8254 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8255 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008256 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008257 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008258 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008259
8260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8264 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8266
8267 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8268 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8269
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008270 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8271 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008272
8273
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008274stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8275 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008277 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008278
8279 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8280 matched.
8281
8282 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8283 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8284
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008285 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8286 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008287 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008288
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008289 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8290 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8291 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8292 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008293
8294 Example :
8295 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8296 backend stats_localhost
8297 stats enable
8298 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8299
8300 Example :
8301 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8302 backend stats_auth
8303 stats enable
8304 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8305 stats admin if TRUE
8306
8307 Example :
8308 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8309 userlist stats-auth
8310 group admin users admin
8311 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8312 group readonly users haproxy
8313 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8314
8315 backend stats_auth
8316 stats enable
8317 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8318 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8319 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8320 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8321
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008322 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8323 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8324 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008325
8326
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008327stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8328 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008330 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008331 Arguments :
8332 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8333
8334 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8335
8336 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8337 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8338 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8339 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8340 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8341 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8342
8343 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8344 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8345 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008346 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008347
8348 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8349 report using "stats scope".
8350
8351 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8352 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8353 unobvious parameters.
8354
8355 Example :
8356 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8357 backend public_www
8358 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8359 stats enable
8360 stats hide-version
8361 stats scope .
8362 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008363 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008364 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8365 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8366
8367 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8368 backend private_monitoring
8369 stats enable
8370 stats uri /admin?stats
8371 stats refresh 5s
8372
8373 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8374
8375
8376stats enable
8377 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008379 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008380 Arguments : none
8381
8382 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8383 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8384 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8385 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8386 - stats auth : no authentication
8387 - stats scope : no restriction
8388
8389 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8390 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8391 unobvious parameters.
8392
8393 Example :
8394 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8395 backend public_www
8396 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8397 stats enable
8398 stats hide-version
8399 stats scope .
8400 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008401 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008402 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8403 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8404
8405 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8406 backend private_monitoring
8407 stats enable
8408 stats uri /admin?stats
8409 stats refresh 5s
8410
8411 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8412
8413
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008414stats hide-version
8415 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008417 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008418 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008419
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008420 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8421 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8422 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8423 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8424 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8425 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008427 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8428 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8429 unobvious parameters.
8430
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008431 Example :
8432 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8433 backend public_www
8434 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008435 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008436 stats hide-version
8437 stats scope .
8438 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008439 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008440 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8441 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008442
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008443 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8444 backend private_monitoring
8445 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008446 stats uri /admin?stats
8447 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008448
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008449 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008450
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008451
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008452stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8453 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8454 Access control for statistics
8455
8456 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8457 no | no | yes | yes
8458
8459 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8460 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8461 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8462 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8463 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8464 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8465
8466 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8467 instance.
8468
8469 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8470 about ACL usage.
8471
8472
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008473stats realm <realm>
8474 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8475 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008476 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008477 Arguments :
8478 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8479 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8480 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8481
8482 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8483 using a backslash ('\').
8484
8485 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8486 only related to authentication.
8487
8488 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8489 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8490 unobvious parameters.
8491
8492 Example :
8493 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8494 backend public_www
8495 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8496 stats enable
8497 stats hide-version
8498 stats scope .
8499 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008500 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008501 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8502 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8503
8504 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8505 backend private_monitoring
8506 stats enable
8507 stats uri /admin?stats
8508 stats refresh 5s
8509
8510 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8511
8512
8513stats refresh <delay>
8514 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008516 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008517 Arguments :
8518 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8519 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8520 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8521 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8522 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8523 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8524
8525 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8526 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8527 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8528 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8529
8530 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8531 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8532 unobvious parameters.
8533
8534 Example :
8535 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8536 backend public_www
8537 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8538 stats enable
8539 stats hide-version
8540 stats scope .
8541 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008542 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008543 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8544 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8545
8546 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8547 backend private_monitoring
8548 stats enable
8549 stats uri /admin?stats
8550 stats refresh 5s
8551
8552 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8553
8554
8555stats scope { <name> | "." }
8556 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008558 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008559 Arguments :
8560 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8561 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8562 section in which the statement appears.
8563
8564 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8565 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8566 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8567 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8568 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8569 exists.
8570
8571 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8572 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8573 unobvious parameters.
8574
8575 Example :
8576 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8577 backend public_www
8578 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8579 stats enable
8580 stats hide-version
8581 stats scope .
8582 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008583 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008584 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8585 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8586
8587 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8588 backend private_monitoring
8589 stats enable
8590 stats uri /admin?stats
8591 stats refresh 5s
8592
8593 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8594
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008595
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008596stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008597 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008599 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008600
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008601 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008602 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8603
8604 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8605 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8606
8607 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8608 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008609 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008610
8611 Example :
8612 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8613 backend private_monitoring
8614 stats enable
8615 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8616 stats uri /admin?stats
8617 stats refresh 5s
8618
8619 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8620 global section.
8621
8622
8623stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008624 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8626 yes | yes | yes | yes
8627 Arguments : none
8628
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008629 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008630 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8631 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8632 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8633 - IP (socket, server)
8634 - cookie (backend, server)
8635
8636 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8637 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008638 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008639
8640 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8641
8642
8643stats show-node [ <name> ]
8644 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008646 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008647 Arguments:
8648 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8649 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8650
8651 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8652 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008653 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008654
8655 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8656 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8657 unobvious parameters.
8658
8659 Example:
8660 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8661 backend private_monitoring
8662 stats enable
8663 stats show-node Europe-1
8664 stats uri /admin?stats
8665 stats refresh 5s
8666
8667 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8668 section.
8669
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008670
8671stats uri <prefix>
8672 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008674 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008675 Arguments :
8676 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8677 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8678 query string.
8679
8680 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8681 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8682 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8683 possible to reach it in the application.
8684
8685 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008686 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008687 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8688 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8689 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8690 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8691
8692 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8693 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8694 an address or a port to statistics only.
8695
8696 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8697 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8698 unobvious parameters.
8699
8700 Example :
8701 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8702 backend public_www
8703 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8704 stats enable
8705 stats hide-version
8706 stats scope .
8707 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008708 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008709 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8710 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8711
8712 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8713 backend private_monitoring
8714 stats enable
8715 stats uri /admin?stats
8716 stats refresh 5s
8717
8718 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8719
8720
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008721stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8722 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008724 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008725
8726 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008727 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008728 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008729 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008730 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8731
8732 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8733 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8734 the "stick-table" statement.
8735
8736 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8737 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8738 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8739 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8740 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8741
8742 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8743 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8744 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8745 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8746 transformation rules.
8747
8748 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8749 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8750 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8751 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8752 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8753 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8754 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8755
8756 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8757 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8758 ACL based conditions.
8759
8760 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8761 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8762 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8763 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8764
8765 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8766 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8767 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8768 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8769
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008770 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8771 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008772 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008773
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008774 Example :
8775 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8776 # last 30 minutes
8777 backend pop
8778 mode tcp
8779 balance roundrobin
8780 stick store-request src
8781 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8782 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8783 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8784
8785 backend smtp
8786 mode tcp
8787 balance roundrobin
8788 stick match src table pop
8789 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8790 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8791
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008792 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008793 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008794
8795
8796stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8797 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8799 no | no | yes | yes
8800
8801 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8802 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8803 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8804 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8805
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008806 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8807 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008808 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008809
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008810 Examples :
8811 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008812 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008813
8814 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8815 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8816 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8817
8818
8819 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8820 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8821 backend http
8822 mode http
8823 balance roundrobin
8824 stick on src table https
8825 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8826 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8827 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8828
8829 backend https
8830 mode tcp
8831 balance roundrobin
8832 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8833 stick on src
8834 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8835 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8836
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008837 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008838
8839
8840stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8841 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8843 no | no | yes | yes
8844
8845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008846 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008847 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008848 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008849 server is selected.
8850
8851 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8852 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8853 the "stick-table" statement.
8854
8855 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8856 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8857 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8858 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8859 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8860 address.
8861
8862 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8863 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8864 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8865 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8866 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8867 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8868 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8869 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8870 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8871 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8872
8873 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8874 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8875 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8876 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8877 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8878 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8879 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8880
8881 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8882 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8883 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8884 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8885
8886 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8887 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8888 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8889 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8890 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8891 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008892 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8893 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8894 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8895 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8896 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8897 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008898
8899 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8900 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8901 the request.
8902
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008903 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8904 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008905 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008906
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008907 Example :
8908 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8909 # last 30 minutes
8910 backend pop
8911 mode tcp
8912 balance roundrobin
8913 stick store-request src
8914 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8915 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8916 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8917
8918 backend smtp
8919 mode tcp
8920 balance roundrobin
8921 stick match src table pop
8922 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8923 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8924
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008925 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008926 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008927
8928
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008929stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008930 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8931 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008932 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008934 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008935
8936 Arguments :
8937 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8938 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8939 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8940 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8941
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008942 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8943 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8944 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8945 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8946
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008947 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8948 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8949 instance.
8950
8951 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8952 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8953 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8954 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8955 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8956 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008957 to 32 characters.
8958
8959 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8960 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8961 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008962 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008963 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8964 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008965
8966 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008967 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8968 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008969 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8970 increase.
8971
8972 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008973 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8974 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8975 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008976
8977 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8978 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8979 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8980 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008981 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008982 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8983 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8984 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8985 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8986 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8987 parameter (see below).
8988
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008989 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8990 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8991 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8992 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8993 soft restart.
8994
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008995 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8996 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008997
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008998 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8999 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9000 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9001 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009002 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009003 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009004 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9005 if not expiration delay is specified.
9006
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009007 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9008 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9009 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9010 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009011 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9012 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9013 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9014 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9015 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9016 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9017 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9018 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9019 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9020 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9021 types and their arguments.
9022
9023 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9024 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9025 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9026 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9027
9028 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9029 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9030 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009031 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009032
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009033 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9034 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9035 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009036 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009037 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009038 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009039
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009040 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9041 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9042 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9043 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9044
9045 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9046 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9047 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9048 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9049 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9050 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9051
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009052 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9053 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9054 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9055 they were received.
9056
9057 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9058 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9059 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9060 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9061 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9062
9063 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9064 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9065 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9066 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9067 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9068
9069 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9070 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9071 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9072
9073 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9074 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9075 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9076 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9077 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9078
9079 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9080 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9081 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9082 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9083 the client side.
9084
9085 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9086 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9087 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9088 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9089 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9090 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9091 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9092
9093 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9094 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9095 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9096 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9097 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9098 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009099 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009100
9101 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9102 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9103 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9104 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9105 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9106 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9107
9108 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009109 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009110 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9111 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9112
9113 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9114 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9115 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9116 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9117 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9118 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9119 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9120 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9121 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9122 recommended for better fairness.
9123
9124 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009125 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009126 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9127 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9128
9129 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9130 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9131 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9132 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9133 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9134 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9135 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9136 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9137 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9138 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009139
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009140 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9141 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009142 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9143 reference it.
9144
9145 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9146 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009147 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9148 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9149 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009150
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009151 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9152 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9153 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9154 something that can be ignored.
9155
9156 Example:
9157 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9158 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9159 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9160 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9161
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009162 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009163 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009164
9165
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009166stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009167 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9169 no | no | yes | yes
9170
9171 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009172 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009173 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009174 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009175 server is selected.
9176
9177 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9178 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9179 the "stick-table" statement.
9180
9181 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9182 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9183 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9184 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9185
9186 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9187 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9188 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9189 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9190 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9191 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009192 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009193 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9194 rules.
9195
9196 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9197 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9198 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9199 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9200 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9201 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9202 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9203
9204 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9205 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9206 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9207 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9208
9209 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9210 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9211 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9212 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9213 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9214 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009215 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9216 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9217 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9218 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9219 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9220 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9221 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9222 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9223 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009224
9225 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9226
9227 Example :
9228 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9229 backend https
9230 mode tcp
9231 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009232 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009233 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009234
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009235 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9236 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9237
9238 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9239 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9240 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9241
9242 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9243 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009244
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009245 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9246 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9247 # at offset 44.
9248
9249 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9250 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9251
9252 # Learn on response if server hello.
9253 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009254
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009255 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9256 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9257
9258 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9259 extraction.
9260
9261
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009262tcp-check connect [params*]
9263 Opens a new connection
9264 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9265 no | no | yes | yes
9266
9267 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9268 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9269 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9270
9271 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9272 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9273 of the sequence.
9274
9275 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9276 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9277 do.
9278
9279 Parameters :
9280 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9281 use the TCP connection.
9282
9283 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9284 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9285 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9286
9287 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9288
9289 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9290
9291 Examples:
9292 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9293 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9294 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9295 option tcp-check
9296 tcp-check connect
9297 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9298 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9299 tcp-check send \r\n
9300 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9301 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9302 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9303 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9304 tcp-check send \r\n
9305 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9306 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9307
9308 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9309 option tcp-check
9310 tcp-check connect port 110
9311 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9312 tcp-check connect port 143
9313 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9314 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9315
9316 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9317
9318
9319tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009320 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9322 no | no | yes | yes
9323
9324 Arguments :
9325 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9326 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9327 binary.
9328 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9329 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9330 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9331
9332 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9333 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9334 with the usual backslash ('\').
9335 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009336 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009337 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9338 used upper or lower case.
9339
9340
9341 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9342
9343 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9344 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9345 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9346 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9347 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9348 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9349 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9350 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9351
9352 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9353 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9354 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9355 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9356 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9357 expression.
9358
9359 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9360 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9361 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9362 this exact hexadecimal string.
9363 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9364
9365 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9366 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9367 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9368 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9369 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9370 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9371 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9372 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9373 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9374 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9375 the null character.
9376
9377 Examples :
9378 # perform a POP check
9379 option tcp-check
9380 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9381
9382 # perform an IMAP check
9383 option tcp-check
9384 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9385
9386 # look for the redis master server
9387 option tcp-check
9388 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009389 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009390 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9391 tcp-check expect string role:master
9392 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9393 tcp-check expect string +OK
9394
9395
9396 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9397 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9398
9399
9400tcp-check send <data>
9401 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9402 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9403 no | no | yes | yes
9404
9405 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9406 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9407
9408 Examples :
9409 # look for the redis master server
9410 option tcp-check
9411 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9412 tcp-check expect string role:master
9413
9414 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9415 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9416
9417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009418tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9419 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009420 tcp health check
9421 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9422 no | no | yes | yes
9423
9424 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9425 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009426 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009427 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9428 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9429 hexadecimal string.
9430 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9431
9432 Examples :
9433 # redis check in binary
9434 option tcp-check
9435 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9436 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9437
9438
9439 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9440 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9441
9442
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009443tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9444 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9446 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009447 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009448 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9449 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009451 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009452
9453 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9454 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009455 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9456 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9457 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9458 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9459 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9460 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009461
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009462 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9463 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9464 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9465 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009466
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009467 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009468 - accept :
9469 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9470 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9471 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009472
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009473 - reject :
9474 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9475 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9476 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9477 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9478 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9479 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9480 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9481 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9482 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9483 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9484 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009485 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009486
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009487 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9488 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9489 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9490 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9491 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9492 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9493 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9494 hosts.
9495
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009496 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9497 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9498 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9499 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9500 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9501 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9502 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9503 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9504
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009505 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9506 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9507 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9508 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9509 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9510 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9511 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9512 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9513 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009514 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9515 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009516
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009517 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009518 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009519 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9520 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9521 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9522 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9523 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9524 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9525 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9526 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9527 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9528 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9529 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9530 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009531
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009532 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009533 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009534 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009535 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009536 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9537 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9538 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009539
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009540 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9541 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9542 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9543 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009544
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009545 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9546 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9547 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9548 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9549 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009550 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9551 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9552 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9553 layer7 information is extracted.
9554
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009555 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9556 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9557 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9558 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9559 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009560
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009561 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9562 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9563 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9564 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9565
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009566 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9567 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9568 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9569 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9570
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009571 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9572 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9573 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9574 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9575 continues.
9576
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009577 - set-src <expr> :
9578 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9579 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9580 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009581 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009582
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009583 Arguments:
9584 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9585 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009586
9587 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009588 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9589
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009590 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9591 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009592
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009593 - set-src-port <expr> :
9594 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9595 expression.
9596
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009597 Arguments:
9598 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9599 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009600
9601 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009602 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9603
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009604 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9605 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9606 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009607
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009608 - set-dst <expr> :
9609 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9610 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9611 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9612 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9613 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9614
9615 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9616 followed by some converters.
9617
9618 Example:
9619
9620 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9621 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9622
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009623 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9624 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9625
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009626 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9627 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9628 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9629 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9630
9631
9632 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9633 followed by some converters.
9634
9635 Example:
9636
9637 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9638
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009639 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9640 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9641 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9642
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009643 - "silent-drop" :
9644 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009645 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009646 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9647 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9648 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9649 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9650 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009651 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9652 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009653 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9654 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009655 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009656 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9657 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9658 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9659 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9660
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009661 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9662 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9663 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009664
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009665 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9666 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9667 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009668
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009669 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009670 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009671 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009672
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009673 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9674 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9675 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009676
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009677 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009678 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9679 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009680
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009681 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9682
9683 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9684
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009685 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9686
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009687 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009688
9689
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009690tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9691 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009693 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009694 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009695 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9696 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009697
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009698 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009699
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009700 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009701 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9702 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9703 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9704 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009705
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009706 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9707 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9708 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9709 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009710 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9711 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9712 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9713 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9714 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9715 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009716 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009717 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009718
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009719 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9720 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9721 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9722 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009723
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009724 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009725 - accept : the request is accepted
9726 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9727 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009728 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009729 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009730 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009731 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009732 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009733 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009734 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009735 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009736 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009737
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009738 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9739 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009740
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009741 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9742 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9743 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9744 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9745 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9746 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009747
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009748 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009749 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9750 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009751
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009752 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009753 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9754 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9755 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9756 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009757 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9758 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9759 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009760
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009761 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009762 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9763 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9764 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009765
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009766 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009767 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9768 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009769
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009770 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9771 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009772 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009773 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9774 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009775 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009776 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009777 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009778 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9779 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009780 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009781 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9782 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009783
9784 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9785 followed by some converters.
9786
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009787 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9788 <var-name>.
9789
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009790 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9791 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9792 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9793 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9794 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9795
9796 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9797 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9798 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9799 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9800 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9801 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9802 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9803 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9804 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9805 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9806 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9807
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009808 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9809 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9810 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9811 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9812 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9813
9814 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9815
9816 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9817
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009818 Example:
9819
9820 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009821 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009822
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009823 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009824 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9825 # and reject everything else.
9826 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9827 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009828 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009829 tcp-request content reject
9830
9831 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009832 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9833 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9834 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009835 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009836
9837 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9838 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9839 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009840 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009841 tcp-request content reject
9842
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009843 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009844 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009845 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009846 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009847 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9848 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009849
9850 Example:
9851 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9852 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009853 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009854
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009855 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009856 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009857
9858 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009859 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009860 # protecting all our sites
9861 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009862 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9863 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009864 ...
9865 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9866
9867 backend http_dynamic
9868 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009869 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009870 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009871 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009872 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009873 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009874 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009876 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009877
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009878 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9879 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009880
9881
9882tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9883 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009885 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009886 Arguments :
9887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9889 as explained at the top of this document.
9890
9891 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9892 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9893 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9894 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9895 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9896
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009897 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9898 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9899 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9900 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9901
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009902 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9903 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009904 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009905 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009906 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9907 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9908 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9909 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009910
9911 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9912 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9913 it pass through unaffected.
9914
9915 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9916 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9917 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009918 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009919 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9920 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009921 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9922 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9923 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009924
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009925 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009926 "timeout client".
9927
9928
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009929tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9930 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9932 no | no | yes | yes
9933 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009934 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9935 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009936
9937 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9938
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009939 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009940 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9941 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009942 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9943 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009944
9945 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9946
9947 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9948 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9949 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9950 inserted.
9951
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009952 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009953 - accept :
9954 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9955 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9956 the rules evaluation.
9957
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009958 - close :
9959 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9960 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9961 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9962 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9963 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9964 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009965 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009966 protocols.
9967
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009968 - reject :
9969 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9970 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009971 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009972
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009973 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9974 Sets a variable.
9975
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009976 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9977 Unsets a variable.
9978
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009979 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9980 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9981 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9982 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9983
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009984 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9985 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9986 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9987 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9988
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009989 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9990 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9991 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9992 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9993 continues.
9994
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009995 - "silent-drop" :
9996 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009997 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009998 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9999 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10000 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10001 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10002 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010003 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10004 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010005 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10006 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010007 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010008 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10009 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10010 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10011 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10012
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010013 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10014 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10015
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010016 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10017 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10018 for changing the default action to a reject.
10019
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010020 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10021 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10022 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10023 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010024 period.
10025
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010026 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10027 declared inline.
10028
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010029 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10030 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010031 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010032 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10033 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010034 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010035 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010036 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010037 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10038 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010039 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010040 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10041 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010042
10043 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10044 followed by some converters.
10045
10046 Example:
10047
10048 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10049
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010050 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10051 <var-name>.
10052
10053 Example:
10054
10055 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10056
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010057 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10058 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10059 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10060 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10061 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10062
10063 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10064
10065 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10066
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010067 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10068
10069 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10070
10071
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010072tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10073 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10075 no | yes | yes | no
10076 Arguments :
10077 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10078 below.
10079
10080 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10081
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010082 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010083 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10084 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10085 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10086 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10087 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10088 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10089 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010090 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010091 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10092 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10093 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10094 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10095 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10096 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10097 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10098 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10099 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10100 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10101 instead.
10102
10103 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10104 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10105 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10106 rules which may be inserted.
10107
10108 Several types of actions are supported :
10109 - accept : the request is accepted
10110 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10111 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10112 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010113 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010114 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10115 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010116 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010117 - silent-drop
10118
10119 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10120 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10121 sections for a complete description.
10122
10123 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10124 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10125 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10126
10127 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10128 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10129 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10130 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10131 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10132
10133 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10134 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10135
10136 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10137 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10138 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10139
10140 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10141 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10142 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10143
10144 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10145 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10146 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10147
10148 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10149 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10150 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10151
10152 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10153
10154 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10155
10156
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010157tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10158 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10160 no | no | yes | yes
10161 Arguments :
10162 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10163 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10164 as explained at the top of this document.
10165
10166 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10167
10168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010169timeout check <timeout>
10170 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10171 established.
10172
10173 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10174 yes | no | yes | yes
10175 Arguments:
10176 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10177 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10178 as explained at the top of this document.
10179
10180 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10181 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010182 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010183 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010184 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10185 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10186 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010187
10188 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10189 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10190
10191 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10192 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010193 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010194
10195 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10196 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10197 forget about it.
10198
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010199 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10200 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010201
10202
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010203timeout client <timeout>
10204timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10205 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10207 yes | yes | yes | no
10208 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010209 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010210 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10211 as explained at the top of this document.
10212
10213 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10214 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10215 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010216 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10217 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10218 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10219 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010220 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10221 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10222 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010223 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010224 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010225 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10226 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010227 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10228 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010229
10230 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10231 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10232 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10233 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10234 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10235 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10236
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010237 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010238
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010239 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10240 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10241 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10242
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010243 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10244 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010245
10246
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010247timeout client-fin <timeout>
10248 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10250 yes | yes | yes | no
10251 Arguments :
10252 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10253 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10254 as explained at the top of this document.
10255
10256 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10257 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10258 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10259 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10260 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10261 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10262 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010263 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10264 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10265 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010266
10267 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10268 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10269 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10270
10271 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10272
10273
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010274timeout connect <timeout>
10275timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10276 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10278 yes | no | yes | yes
10279 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10282 as explained at the top of this document.
10283
10284 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010285 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010286 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010287 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010288 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10289 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010290
10291 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10292 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10293 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10294 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10295 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10296 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10297
10298 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10299 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10300 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10301
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010302 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10303 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010304
10305
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010306timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10307 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10309 yes | yes | yes | yes
10310 Arguments :
10311 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10312 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10313 as explained at the top of this document.
10314
10315 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10316 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10317 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10318 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10319 once the request has started to present itself.
10320
10321 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10322 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10323 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10324 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10325 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10326
10327 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10328 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10329 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10330 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10331
10332 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10333 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010334 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010335 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10336 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010337 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010338
10339 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10340 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10341 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10342 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10343
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010344 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10345 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010346 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10347
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010348 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10349
10350
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010351timeout http-request <timeout>
10352 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010354 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010355 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010356 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010357 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10358 as explained at the top of this document.
10359
10360 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10361 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10362 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10363 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10364 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10365 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10366 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010367 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10368 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10369 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10370 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010371 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010372 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10373 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010374
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010375 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10376 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10377 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10378 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10379 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010380 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010381
10382 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10383 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010384 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010385 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10386 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10387
10388 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010389 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10390 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10391 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010392
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010393 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010394 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010395
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010396
10397timeout queue <timeout>
10398 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10400 yes | no | yes | yes
10401 Arguments :
10402 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10403 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10404 as explained at the top of this document.
10405
10406 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10407 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10408 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10409 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10410 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10411
10412 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10413 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10414 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10415 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10416
10417 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10418
10419
10420timeout server <timeout>
10421timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10422 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10424 yes | no | yes | yes
10425 Arguments :
10426 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10427 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10428 as explained at the top of this document.
10429
10430 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10431 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10432 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10433 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10434 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10435 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10436 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10437
10438 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10439 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10440 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10441 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10442 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010443 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010444 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010445 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10446 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010447 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10448 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010449
10450 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10451 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10452 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10453 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10454 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10455 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10456
10457 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10458 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10459 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10460
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010461 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010462
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010463
10464timeout server-fin <timeout>
10465 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10466 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10467 yes | no | yes | yes
10468 Arguments :
10469 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10470 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10471 as explained at the top of this document.
10472
10473 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10474 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10475 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10476 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10477 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10478 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10479 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10480 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10481 situations, it should not be needed.
10482
10483 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10484 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10485 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10486
10487 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010489
10490timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010491 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10493 yes | yes | yes | yes
10494 Arguments :
10495 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10496 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10497 as explained at the top of this document.
10498
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010499 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10500 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10501 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10502 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010503
10504 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10505 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10506 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10507 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010508 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010509
10510 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10511
10512
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010513timeout tunnel <timeout>
10514 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10516 yes | no | yes | yes
10517 Arguments :
10518 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10519 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10520 as explained at the top of this document.
10521
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010522 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010523 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10524 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10525 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010526 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10527 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010528 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10529 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10530 specified.
10531
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010532 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10533 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10534 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10535 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10536 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10537 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10538 state.
10539
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010540 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10541 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10542 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10543 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010544 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010545
10546 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10547 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10548 forget about it.
10549
10550 Example :
10551 defaults http
10552 option http-server-close
10553 timeout connect 5s
10554 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010555 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010556 timeout server 30s
10557 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10558
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010559 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010560
10561
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010562transparent (deprecated)
10563 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010565 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010566 Arguments : none
10567
10568 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10569 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10570 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10571 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10572 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10573 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10574 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10575 appropriate server.
10576
10577 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10578
10579 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10580 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10581
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010582 See also: "option transparent"
10583
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010584unique-id-format <string>
10585 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10587 yes | yes | yes | no
10588 Arguments :
10589 <string> is a log-format string.
10590
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010591 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10592 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10593 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10594 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010595
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010596 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10597 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10598 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10599 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10600 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10601 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10602 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10603 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010604
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010605 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10606 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010607
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010608 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010609
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010610 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010611
10612 will generate:
10613
10614 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10615
10616 See also: "unique-id-header"
10617
10618unique-id-header <name>
10619 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10621 yes | yes | yes | no
10622 Arguments :
10623 <name> is the name of the header.
10624
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010625 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10626 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010627
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010628 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010629
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010630 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010631 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10632
10633 will generate:
10634
10635 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10636
10637 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010638
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010639use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010640 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10642 no | yes | yes | no
10643 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010644 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10645 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010646
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010647 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10648 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010649
10650 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10651 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10652 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010653 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010654 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010655 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10656 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010657
10658 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10659 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10660 assign the backend.
10661
10662 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10663 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10664 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10665 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10666 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10667 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10668
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010669 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010670 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010671 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10672 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10673 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10674
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010675 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10676 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10677 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10678 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10679 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10680 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10681 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10682 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10683 cannot be forced from the request.
10684
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010685 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010686 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10687 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10688
10689 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10690 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010691
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010692
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010693use-server <server> if <condition>
10694use-server <server> unless <condition>
10695 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10697 no | no | yes | yes
10698 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010699 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010700
10701 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10702
10703 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10704 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10705 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10706
10707 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10708 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10709 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10710 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10711 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10712 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10713 matches will assign the server.
10714
10715 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10716 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10717 with the next rules until one matches.
10718
10719 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10720 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10721 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10722 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10723
10724 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10725 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10726 stripped.
10727
10728 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10729 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10730 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10731 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10732
10733 Example :
10734 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10735 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10736 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10737 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10738 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10739 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010740 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010741 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10742 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10743
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010744 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010745
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107475. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010748--------------------------
10749
10750The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10751depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10752settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10753written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10754described in this section.
10755
10756
107575.1. Bind options
10758-----------------
10759
10760The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10761as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10762no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10763parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10764while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10765provided immediately after the setting name.
10766
10767The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10768
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010769accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10770 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10771 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10772 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10773 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10774 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10775 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10776 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10777 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10778 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010779 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10780 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10781 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010783accept-proxy
10784 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010785 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10786 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010787 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10788 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10789 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10790 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010791 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010792 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10793 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010794 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10795 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010796
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010797allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010798 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010799 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10800 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10801 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10802 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010803
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010804alpn <protocols>
10805 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10806 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10807 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10808 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10809 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010810 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10811 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10812 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10813 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10814 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10815 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10816 preference, like below :
10817
10818 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010819
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010820backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010010821 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010822 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10823
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010824curves <curves>
10825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10826 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10827 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10828 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10829 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10830 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10831
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010832ecdhe <named curve>
10833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010834 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10835 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010836
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010837ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010838 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10839 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10840 client's certificate.
10841
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010842ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10844 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10845 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10846 error is ignored.
10847
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010848ca-sign-file <cafile>
10849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10850 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10851 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10852 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10853 'generate-certificates' for details.
10854
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010855ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10857 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10858 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10859 'generate-certificates' for details.
10860
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010861ciphers <ciphers>
10862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10863 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000010864 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010865 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010866 information and recommendations see e.g.
10867 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10868 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10869 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10870
10871ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10873 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10874 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10875 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000010876 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
10877 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010878
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010879crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10881 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10882 to verify client's certificate.
10883
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010884crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10886 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10887 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10888 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10889 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10890 file.
10891
10892 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10893 are loaded.
10894
10895 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010896 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010897 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10898 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10899 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10900 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010901 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10902 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010903 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010904
10905 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10906 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10907 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10908 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010909 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10910 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010911
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010912 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010913
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010914 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010915 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10917 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010918 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10919 clients).
10920
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010921 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10922 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10923 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10924 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10925 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10926 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10927 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10928 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10929 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10930 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10931 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10932 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10933 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10934
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010935 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10936 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10937 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10938 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10939 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10940
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010941 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10942 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10943 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10944 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010945
10946 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10947 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10948 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10949 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10950 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10951 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10952 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10953 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10954 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10955
10956 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10957
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010958 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010959 a cert bundle.
10960
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010961 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010962 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10963 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10964 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10965 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10966 provide multi-cert support.
10967
10968 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10969
10970 Filename | CN | SAN
10971 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10972 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010973 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010974 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10975 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10976
10977 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10978 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10979 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10980 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010981 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10982 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10983 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010984
10985 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10986 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10987
10988 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10989 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10990 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10991
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010992crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010993 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010995 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010996 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010997
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010998crt-list <file>
10999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011000 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11001 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011002
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011003 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11004
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011005 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11006 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011007 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011008 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011009
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011010 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11011 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11012 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11013 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11014 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11015 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11016 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11017 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011018
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011019 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011020 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011021 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11022 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11023 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011024
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011025 crt-list file example:
11026 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011027 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011028 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011029 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011030
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011031defer-accept
11032 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11033 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11034 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011035 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011036 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11037 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11038 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11039 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11040 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11041 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11042 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11043
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011044expose-fd listeners
11045 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11046 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011047 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11048 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011049 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011050
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011051force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011052 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011053 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011054 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011055 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011056
11057force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011058 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011059 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011060 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011061
11062force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011063 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011064 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011065 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011066
11067force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011068 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011069 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011070 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011071
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011072force-tlsv13
11073 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11074 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011075 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011076
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011077generate-certificates
11078 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11079 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11080 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11081 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11082 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11083 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11084 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11085 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11086 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11087 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11088 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11089
11090 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11091 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011092 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011093 certificate is used many times.
11094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011095gid <gid>
11096 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11097 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11098 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11099 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11100 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11101
11102group <group>
11103 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11104 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11105 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11106 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11107 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11108
11109id <id>
11110 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11111 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11112 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11113 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11114
11115interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011116 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11117 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11118 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11119 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11120 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11121 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011122 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11123 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11124 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11125 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11126 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11127 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011128
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011129level <level>
11130 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11131 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11132 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011133 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011134 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11135 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11136 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011137 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011138 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011139 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011140 all counters).
11141
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011142severity-output <format>
11143 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11144 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11145 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11146 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11147 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11148 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11149 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11150 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11151 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11152 rfc5424 convention.
11153
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011154maxconn <maxconn>
11155 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11156 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11157 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11158 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11159 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11160 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11161 eat all memory.
11162
11163mode <mode>
11164 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11165 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11166 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11167 UNIX sockets.
11168
11169mss <maxseg>
11170 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11171 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11172 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11173 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11174 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11175 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11176 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11177 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11178 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11179 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11180 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11181
11182name <name>
11183 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11184 page.
11185
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011186namespace <name>
11187 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11188 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11189 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11190 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11191
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011192nice <nice>
11193 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11194 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11195 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11196 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11197 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11198 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11199 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11200 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11201 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11202 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11203 one for an RDP socket.
11204
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011205no-ca-names
11206 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11207 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11208
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011209no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011210 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011211 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011212 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011213 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011214 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11215 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011216
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011217no-tls-tickets
11218 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11219 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11220 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011221 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11222 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011223
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011224no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011225 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011226 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011227 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011228 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011229 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11230 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011231
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011232no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011233 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011234 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011235 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011236 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011237 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11238 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011239
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011240no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011241 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011242 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011243 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011244 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011245 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11246 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011247
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011248no-tlsv13
11249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11250 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11251 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11252 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011253 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11254 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011255
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011256npn <protocols>
11257 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11258 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11259 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11260 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011261 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011262 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11263 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11264 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11265 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11266 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011267
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011268prefer-client-ciphers
11269 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11270 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11271 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011272 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11273 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11274 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011275
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011276process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011277 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011278 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011279 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011280 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11281 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11282 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11283 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011284 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011285 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11286 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11287 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11288 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11289 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011290
11291 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11292
11293 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11294 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11295 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11296 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11297 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11298 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11299 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11300 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011301
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011302proto <name>
11303 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11304 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11305 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11306 in haproxy -vv.
11307 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11308 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011309 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011310 h2" on the bind line.
11311
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011312ssl
11313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011314 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011315 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11316 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011317 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11318 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011319
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011320ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11321 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11322 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11323 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11324
11325ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11326 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11327 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11328 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11329
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011330strict-sni
11331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11332 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11333 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11334 See the "crt" option for more information.
11335
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011336tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011337 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011338 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11339 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011340 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011341 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11342 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11343 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11344 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11345 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11346 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11347 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11348
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011349tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011350 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011351 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11352 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11353 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11354 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11355 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11356 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11357 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011358 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11359 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11360 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011361
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011362tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11363 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011364 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11365 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11366 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11367 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11368 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11369 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11370 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11371 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11372 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11373 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011374 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11375 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11376
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011377transparent
11378 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11379 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11380 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11381 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11382 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11383 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11384 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11385 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11386 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11387 so check for support with your vendor.
11388
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011389v4v6
11390 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11391 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11392 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11393 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011394 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011395
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011396v6only
11397 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11398 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11399 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011400 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11401 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011402
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011403uid <uid>
11404 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11405 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11406 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11407 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11408 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11409
11410user <user>
11411 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11412 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11413 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11414 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11415 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11416
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011417verify [none|optional|required]
11418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11419 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11420 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11421 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11422 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011423 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11424 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11425 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11426 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011427
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114285.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011429------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011431The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11432which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11433arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11434settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11435after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11436Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11437address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011439 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011440 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011441
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011442Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11443keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11444
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011445The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011446
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011447addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011448 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011449 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11450 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11451 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11452 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11453 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011454
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011455agent-check
11456 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011457 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011458 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11459 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11460 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011461
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011462 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011463 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011464 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11465 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11466 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011467
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011468 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11469 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11470 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11471 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11472 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011473
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011474 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011475 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011476
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011477 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11478 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11479 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011480
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011481 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11482 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11483 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011484
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011485 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11486 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11487 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11488 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11489 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011490 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011491 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011492
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011493 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11494 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011495
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011496 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11497 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11498 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11499 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11500 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11501 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11502 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11503 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11504 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011505
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011506 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11507 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011508 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11509 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11510 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011511 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011512
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011513 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011514 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011515
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011516agent-send <string>
11517 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11518 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11519 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11520 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11521 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11522
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011523agent-inter <delay>
11524 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11525 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11526
11527 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11528 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11529 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11530 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11531 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11532 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11533 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11534 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11535 of backends use the same servers.
11536
11537 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11538
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011539agent-addr <addr>
11540 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11541
11542 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11543 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11544 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11545 hostname, it will be resolved.
11546
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011547agent-port <port>
11548 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11549
11550 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11551
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011552alpn <protocols>
11553 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11554 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11555 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11556 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11557 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11558 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11559 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11560 now obsolete NPN extension.
11561 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11562 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11563
11564 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011566backup
11567 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11568 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11569 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11570 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011571 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11572 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011573
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011574ca-file <cafile>
11575 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11576 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11577 server's certificate.
11578
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011579check
11580 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011581 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11582 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11583 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11584 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11585 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11586 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11587 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011588 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11589 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011590 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11591 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011592
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011593check-send-proxy
11594 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11595 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11596 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11597 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11598 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11599 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11600 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11601
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011602check-alpn <protocols>
11603 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11604 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11605 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11606
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011607check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011608 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011609 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11610 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011611
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011612check-ssl
11613 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11614 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11615 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11616 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011617 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011618 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11619 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011620 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011621 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11622 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011623
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011624ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11626 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11627 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011628 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
11629 information and recommendations see e.g.
11630 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11631 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11632 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011633
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011634ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11636 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11637 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11638 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011639 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
11640 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
11641 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011642
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011643cookie <value>
11644 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11645 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11646 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11647 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11648 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11649 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11650 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11651
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011652crl-file <crlfile>
11653 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11654 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11655 to verify server's certificate.
11656
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011657crt <cert>
11658 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11659 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11660 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11661 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11662 certificate request.
11663
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011664disabled
11665 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11666 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11667 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11668 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11669 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011670 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011671
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011672enabled
11673 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11674 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11675 default value.
11676 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11677 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011678
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011679error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011680 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11681 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11682 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011683
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011684 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011685
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011686fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011687 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11688 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11689 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11690
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011691force-sslv3
11692 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11693 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011694 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011695 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011696
11697force-tlsv10
11698 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011699 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011700 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011701
11702force-tlsv11
11703 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011704 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011705 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011706
11707force-tlsv12
11708 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011709 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011710 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011711
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011712force-tlsv13
11713 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11714 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011715 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011717id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011718 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11719 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11720 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011721
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011722init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11723 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11724 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011725 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011726 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11727 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11728 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11729 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11730 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11731 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11732 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11733 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11734 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011735 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011736 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11737 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11738 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11739 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11740 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11741 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011742 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011743
11744 Example:
11745 defaults
11746 # never fail on address resolution
11747 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011749inter <delay>
11750fastinter <delay>
11751downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011752 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11753 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11754 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11755 between checks depending on the server state :
11756
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011757 Server state | Interval used
11758 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11759 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11760 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11761 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11762 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11763 or yet unchecked. |
11764 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11765 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11766 | "inter" otherwise.
11767 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011768
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011769 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11770 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11771 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11772 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011773 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11774 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11775 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11776 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11777 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011778
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011779maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011780 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11781 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11782 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11783 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11784 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11785 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11786 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11787 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11788
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011789maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011790 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11791 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11792 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11793 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11794 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11795 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11796 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11797
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011798max-reuse <count>
11799 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11800 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11801 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11802 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11803 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11804 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11805 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11806 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011808minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011809 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11810 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11811 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11812 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11813 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11814 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011815 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011816 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011817
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011818namespace <name>
11819 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11820 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11821 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11822 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11823
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011824no-agent-check
11825 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11826 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11827 default value.
11828 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11829 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11830
11831no-backup
11832 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11833 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11834 default value.
11835 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11836 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11837
11838no-check
11839 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11840 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11841 default value.
11842 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11843 "default-server" "check" setting.
11844
11845no-check-ssl
11846 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11847 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11848 default value.
11849 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11850 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11851
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011852no-send-proxy
11853 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11854 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11855 default value.
11856 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11857 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11858
11859no-send-proxy-v2
11860 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11861 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11862 default value.
11863 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11864 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11865
11866no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11867 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11868 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11869 default value.
11870 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11871 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11872
11873no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11874 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11875 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11876 default value.
11877 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11878 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11879
11880no-ssl
11881 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11882 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11883 default value.
11884 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11885 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11886
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011887no-ssl-reuse
11888 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11889 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11890 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11891 and for paranoid users.
11892
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011893no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011894 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11895 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011896 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011897
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011898 Supported in default-server: No
11899
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011900no-tls-tickets
11901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11902 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11903 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011904 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11905 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011906 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011907
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011908no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011909 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011910 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11911 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011912 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11913 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011914 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011915
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011916 Supported in default-server: No
11917
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011918no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011919 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011920 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11921 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011922 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11923 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011924 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011925
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011926 Supported in default-server: No
11927
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011928no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011929 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011930 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11931 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011932 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11933 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011934 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011935
11936 Supported in default-server: No
11937
11938no-tlsv13
11939 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11940 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11941 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11942 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11943 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011944 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011945
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011946 Supported in default-server: No
11947
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011948no-verifyhost
11949 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11950 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11951 default value.
11952 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11953 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011954
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011955non-stick
11956 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11957 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11958 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11959
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011960npn <protocols>
11961 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11962 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11963 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11964 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
11965 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
11966 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11967 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
11968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011969observe <mode>
11970 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11971 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11972 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11973 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11974 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11975 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011976 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011977
11978 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011980on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011981 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11982 Currently, four modes are available:
11983 - fastinter: force fastinter
11984 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11985 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11986 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11987 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11988
11989 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11990
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011991on-marked-down <action>
11992 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11993 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011994 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11995 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11996 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11997 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11998 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11999 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12000 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12001 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012002
12003 Actions are disabled by default
12004
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012005on-marked-up <action>
12006 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12007 Currently one action is available:
12008 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12009 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12010 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12011 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012012 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12013 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012014 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12015 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12016
12017 Actions are disabled by default
12018
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012019pool-max-conn <max>
12020 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12021 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12022 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12023 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12024 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12025 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12026
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012027pool-purge-delay <delay>
12028 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012029 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
12030 The default is 1s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012032port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012033 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12034 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12035 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12036 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12037 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12038 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12039
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012040proto <name>
12041
12042 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12043 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12044 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12045 reported in haproxy -vv.
12046 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12047 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012049redir <prefix>
12050 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12051 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12052 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12053 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12054 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12055 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12056 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12057 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012058 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012059 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012060 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12061 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12062 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12063 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12064
12065 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012067rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012068 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12069 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12070 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12071
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012072resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12073 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12074 server.
12075
12076 Available options:
12077
12078 * allow-dup-ip
12079 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12080 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12081 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12082 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12083 For such case, simply enable this option.
12084 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12085
12086 * prevent-dup-ip
12087 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12088 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12089 same fqdn.
12090 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12091
12092 Example:
12093 backend b_myapp
12094 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12095 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12096 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12097
12098 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12099 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12100 it
12101 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12102 different address
12103
12104 Default value: not set
12105
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012106resolve-prefer <family>
12107 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12108 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12109 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12110 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12111
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012112 Default value: ipv6
12113
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012114 Example:
12115
12116 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012117
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012118resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12119 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12120 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012121 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012122 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12123 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012124 configured network, another address is selected.
12125
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012126 Example:
12127
12128 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012129
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012130resolvers <id>
12131 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12132 hostname.
12133
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012134 Example:
12135
12136 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012137
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012138 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012139
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012140send-proxy
12141 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12142 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12143 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12144 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012145 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12146 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12147 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12148 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12149 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12150 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12151 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12152 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12153 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12154 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012155 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12156 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012157
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012158send-proxy-v2
12159 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12160 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12161 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12162 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012163 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12164 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12165 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12166 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012167
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012168proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12169 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12170 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012171 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12172 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012173 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12174 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012175 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012176
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012177send-proxy-v2-ssl
12178 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12179 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12180 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12181 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12182 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12183 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12184 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012185 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12186 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012187
12188send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12189 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12190 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12191 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12192 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12193 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12194 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12195 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12196 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012197 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12198 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012199
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012200slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012201 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12202 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12203 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12204 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12205 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12206 parameters :
12207
12208 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12209 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12210
12211 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12212 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12213 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12214 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12215
12216 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12217 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12218 seen as failed.
12219
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012220sni <expression>
12221 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12222 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12223 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12224 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012225 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12226 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012227 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012228 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12229 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012230
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012231source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012232source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012233source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012234 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12235 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12236 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12237 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12238
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012239 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12240 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12241 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12242 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12243 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12244 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12245 server.
12246
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012247 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12248 specifying the source address without port(s).
12249
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012250ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012251 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12252 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12253 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12254 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12255 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12256 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012257 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12258 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012259
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012260ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12261 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12262 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12263 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12264
12265ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12266 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12267 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12268 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12269
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012270ssl-reuse
12271 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12272 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12273 default value.
12274 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12275 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12276
12277stick
12278 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12279 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12280 default value.
12281 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12282 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012283
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012284tcp-ut <delay>
12285 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12286 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12287 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012288 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012289 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12290 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12291 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12292 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12293 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12294 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12295 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12296 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12297 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12298
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012299track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012300 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12301 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12302 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12303 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012304 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12305
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012306tls-tickets
12307 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12308 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12309 default value.
12310 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12311 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012312
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012313verify [none|required]
12314 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012315 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012316 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12317 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012318 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012319 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12320 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12321 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12322 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12323 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12324 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12325 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12326 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012327
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012328verifyhost <hostname>
12329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012330 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12331 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12332 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12333 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12334 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12335 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12336 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12337 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012338
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012339weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012340 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12341 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12342 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012343 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12344 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12345 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12346 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12347 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12348 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012349
12350
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123515.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12352-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012353
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012354HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12355using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12356configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012357This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12358can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12359workload.
12360This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12361resolution at run time.
12362Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12363carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12364
12365
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123665.3.1. Global overview
12367----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012368
12369As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12370different steps of the process life:
12371
12372 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12373 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12374 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12375
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012376 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12377 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012378
12379A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12380 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12381 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12382 resolution to know this new IP.
12383
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012384When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012385HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012386SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12387from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12388will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12389will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012390
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012391A few things important to notice:
12392 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12393 first valid response.
12394
12395 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12396 servers return an error.
12397
12398
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123995.3.2. The resolvers section
12400----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012401
12402This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012403HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12404contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012405
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012406When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12407uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12408is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12409answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12410
12411When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012412used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012413
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012414 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12415 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12416 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012417
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012418 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12419 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012420
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012421 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12422 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12423 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012424
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012425For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12426following scenarios are possible:
12427
12428 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12429 ignored
12430
12431 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12432 applied
12433
12434 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12435 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12436
12437 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12438 retries the query with a new type
12439
12440 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12441 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012442
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012443As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12444a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012445<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012446
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012447
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012448resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012449 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012450
12451A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12452
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012453accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012454 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012455 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012456 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12457 by RFC 6891)
12458
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012459 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12460
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012461nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12462 DNS server description:
12463 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12464 <ip> : IP address of the server
12465 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12466
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012467parse-resolv-conf
12468 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12469 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12470 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12471
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012472hold <status> <period>
12473 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12474 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012475 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012476 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012477 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12478 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12479 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12480
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012481 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012482
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012483resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012484 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12485 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12486 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12487
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012488resolve_retries <nb>
12489 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12490 giving up.
12491 Default value: 3
12492
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012493 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12494 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12495 type.
12496
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012497timeout <event> <time>
12498 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12499 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12500 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012501 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12502 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012503 Default value: 1s
12504 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012505 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012506 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012507 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12508 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12509
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012510 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012511
12512 resolvers mydns
12513 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12514 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012515 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012516 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012517 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012518 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012519 hold other 30s
12520 hold refused 30s
12521 hold nx 30s
12522 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012523 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012524 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012525
12526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125276. HTTP header manipulation
12528---------------------------
12529
12530In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12531response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12532request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12533which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012534against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012535
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012536If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12537to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12538but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12539HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12540stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12541because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12542a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12543still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012545This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12546in section 4.2 :
12547
12548 - reqadd <string>
12549 - reqallow <search>
12550 - reqiallow <search>
12551 - reqdel <search>
12552 - reqidel <search>
12553 - reqdeny <search>
12554 - reqideny <search>
12555 - reqpass <search>
12556 - reqipass <search>
12557 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12558 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12559 - reqtarpit <search>
12560 - reqitarpit <search>
12561 - rspadd <string>
12562 - rspdel <search>
12563 - rspidel <search>
12564 - rspdeny <search>
12565 - rspideny <search>
12566 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12567 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12568
12569With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12570is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12571parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12572prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12573Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12574
12575 \t for a tab
12576 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12577 \n for a new line (LF)
12578 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12579 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12580 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12581 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12582 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12583
12584The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12585portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12586above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12587regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
125889 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12589is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12590
12591The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12592after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12593
12594Notes related to these keywords :
12595---------------------------------
12596 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12597 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12598 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12599
12600 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12601 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12602 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12603
12604 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12605 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12606 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12607 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12608 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12609
12610 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12611 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12612 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12613 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12614 useless headers before adding new ones.
12615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012616 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012617 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12618
12619 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12620 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12621 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12622
12623 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12624 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012625 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012626
12627
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126287. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12629----------------------------------
12630
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012631HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012632client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12633The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12634these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12635but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12636data called patterns.
12637
12638
126397.1. ACL basics
12640---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012641
12642The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12643content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12644from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12645simple :
12646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012647 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012648 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012649 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12650 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012652The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12653adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012654
12655In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012657 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012658
12659This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12660Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12661and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012662an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12663conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12664as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12665are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012666
12667ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12668'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12669which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12670
12671There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12672performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012674The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12675specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12676this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012677methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12678ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012679
12680Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12681 - boolean
12682 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12683 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12684 - string
12685 - data block
12686
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012687Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12688converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12689would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12690The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12691which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12692
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012693Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12694keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12695fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12696which are summarized in the table below :
12697
12698 +---------------------+-----------------+
12699 | Sample or converter | Default |
12700 | output type | matching method |
12701 +---------------------+-----------------+
12702 | boolean | bool |
12703 +---------------------+-----------------+
12704 | integer | int |
12705 +---------------------+-----------------+
12706 | ip | ip |
12707 +---------------------+-----------------+
12708 | string | str |
12709 +---------------------+-----------------+
12710 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12711 +---------------------+-----------------+
12712
12713Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12714matching method, see below.
12715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012716The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12717 - boolean
12718 - integer or integer range
12719 - IP address / network
12720 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12721 - regular expression
12722 - hex block
12723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12725
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012726 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12727 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012728 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012729 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012730 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012731 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012732 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012734The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12735read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12736if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12737lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12738will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12739beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12740a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12741lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12742exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12743
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012744The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12745parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12746ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12747a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12748check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12749
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012750The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12751socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12752file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12755loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12756
12757 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12758
12759In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12760the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12761case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12762as well.
12763
12764The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12765sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12766do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12767methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12768is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012769obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012770followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12771default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12772that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12773string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12774
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012775The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12776By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12777string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12778resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12779server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12780waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12781flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12782function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012784There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12785sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12786be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012787
12788 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12789 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012790 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12791 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12792 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12793 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012794
12795 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12796 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012797 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012798
12799 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012800 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012801
12802 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012803 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012804
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012805 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012806 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12807
12808 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12809 binary or string samples.
12810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012811 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12812 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12815 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12816 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012818 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12819 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012821 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12822 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012824 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12825 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012827 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12828 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012829 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012831 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12832 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12833 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012834
12835For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12836request, it is possible to do :
12837
12838 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12839
12840In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12841buffer, one would use the following acl :
12842
12843 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12844
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012845On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12846possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12847
12848 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012850All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12851criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12852method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12853to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12854criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12855the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012857If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012858the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12859For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012861 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12862 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12863 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12864 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012865
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012866
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012867The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12868types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12869combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12870brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12871default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012873 +-------------------------------------------------+
12874 | Input sample type |
12875 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012876 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012877 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12878 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12879 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012880 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012882 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012884 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012886 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012887 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012888 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012889 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012890 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012891 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012892 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012894 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012895 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012896 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012897 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012898 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012899 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012900 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012901 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12902 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12903 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012904
12905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129067.1.1. Matching booleans
12907------------------------
12908
12909In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12910Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12911When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12912that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12913
12914Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12915return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12916"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12917
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129197.1.2. Matching integers
12920------------------------
12921
12922Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12923enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12924to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12925
12926Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12927matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12928lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012929
12930For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12931unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12932representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12933
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012934As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12935two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12936instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12937ranges and operators.
12938
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012939For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012940operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12941Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12942of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012943
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012944Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012945
12946 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12947 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12948 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12949 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12950 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012952For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012953
12954 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12955
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012956This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12957
12958 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12959
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129617.1.3. Matching strings
12962-----------------------
12963
12964String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12965different forms :
12966
12967 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012968 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012969
12970 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012971 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012972
12973 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12974 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12975
12976 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12977 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12978
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012979 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012980 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12981 matches.
12982
12983 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12984 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12985 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012986
12987String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12988exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12989characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12990string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12991to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012992before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012993
12994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129957.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12996---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012997
12998Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12999they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13000possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13001passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13002the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013003the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13004match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013005
13006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130077.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13008-------------------------------------
13009
13010It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13011not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13012a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13013to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13014digits may be used upper or lower case.
13015
13016Example :
13017 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13018 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13019
13020
130217.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13022---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013023
13024IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13025netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13026within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013027host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013028difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13029at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13030does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13031parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013032
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013033The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13034abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13035
13036 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13037 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13038 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13039 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13040 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13041 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13042 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13043 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13044
13045Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13046192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13047
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013048IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13049Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13050trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13051IPv6 patterns.
13052
13053HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13054following situations :
13055 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13056 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13057 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13058 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13059 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13060 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13061 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13062 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13063 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13064 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013066
130677.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13068----------------------------------
13069
13070Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13071combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13072
13073 - AND (implicit)
13074 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13075 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013077A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013079 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013081Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13082indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013084For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13085"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13086requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13087is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13088
13089 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013090 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13091 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13092 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013093
13094To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13095and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13096
13097 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13098 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13099 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13100 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13101
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013102 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013103 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13104 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13105 use_backend www if host_www
13106
13107It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13108expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13109be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13110the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13111
13112 The following rule :
13113
13114 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013115 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116
13117 Can also be written that way :
13118
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013119 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013120
13121It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13122to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13123simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13124sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13125good use is the following :
13126
13127 With named ACLs :
13128
13129 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13130 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13131 monitor fail if site_dead
13132
13133 With anonymous ACLs :
13134
13135 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13136
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013137See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13138keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139
13140
131417.3. Fetching samples
13142---------------------
13143
13144Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13145against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13146sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13147ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13148of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13149available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13150
13151This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13152Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13153compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13154deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13155
13156The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13157matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13158method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13159indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13160
13161As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13162when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13163mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13164the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13165ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13166
13167Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13168multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13169when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013170incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13171are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013172is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13173all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13174
13175Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13176 - name
13177 - name(arg1)
13178 - name(arg1,arg2)
13179
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013180
131817.3.1. Converters
13182-----------------
13183
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013184Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13185of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13186is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13187was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013188has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013189unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13190
13191These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13192sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13193the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013194support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013195
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013196A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13197support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13198supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13199(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13200bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013202The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013203
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001320451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13205 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13206 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13207 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13208 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13209 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13210
13211 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013212 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13213 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013214 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13215 frontend http-in
13216 bind *:8081
13217 default_backend servers
13218 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13219 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13220
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013221add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013222 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013223 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013224 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13225 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013226 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013227 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13228 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13229 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13230 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013231 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013232 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013233
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013234aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13235 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13236 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13237 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13238 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13239 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13240 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13241
13242 Example:
13243 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13244 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13245
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013246and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013247 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013248 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013249 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13250 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013251 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013252 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13253 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13254 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13255 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013256 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013257 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013258
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013259b64dec
13260 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13261 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13262
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013263base64
13264 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013265 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013266 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13267
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013268bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013269 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013270 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013271 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013272 presence of a flag).
13273
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013274bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13275 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13276 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013277 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013278
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013279concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13280 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13281 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13282 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13283 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13284 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13285 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13286 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13287 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13288 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13289 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13290 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13291 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13292 delimitors.
13293
13294 Example:
13295 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13296 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13297 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13298 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13299
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013300cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013301 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13302 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013303
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013304crc32([<avalanche>])
13305 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13306 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13307 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13308 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13309 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13310 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13311 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13312 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13313 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13314 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013315 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13316
13317crc32c([<avalanche>])
13318 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13319 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13320 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13321 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13322 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13323 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13324 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13325 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013326
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013327da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013328 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13329 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13330 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13331 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013332 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013333 configuration language.
13334
13335 Example:
13336 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013337 bind *:8881
13338 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013339 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013340
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013341debug
13342 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13343 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13344 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13345
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013346div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013347 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13348 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013349 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013350 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13351 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013352 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013353 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13354 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13355 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13356 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013357 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013358 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013359
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013360djb2([<avalanche>])
13361 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13362 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13363 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13364 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13365 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13366 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13367 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013368 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13369 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013370
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013371even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013372 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013373 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13374
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013375field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13376 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13377 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13378 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13379 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13380 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13381 fields.
13382
13383 Example :
13384 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13385 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13386 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13387 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13388 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013389
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013390hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013391 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013392 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013393 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013394 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013395
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013396hex2i
13397 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13398 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13399
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013400http_date([<offset>])
13401 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13402 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13403 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13404 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13405 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13406 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013407
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013408in_table(<table>)
13409 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13410 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13411 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013412 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013413 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13414
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013415ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13416 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013417 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013418 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13419 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13420 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13421 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13422 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013423
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013424json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013425 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013426 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013427 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013428 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13429 of errors:
13430 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13431 bytes, ...)
13432 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13433 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13434
13435 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13436 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13437 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13438 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13439 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13440 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013441 - "ascii" : never fails;
13442 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13443 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013444 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013445 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013446 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13447 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13448
13449 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013450 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013451
13452 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013453 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013454 capture request header user-agent len 150
13455 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013456
13457 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13458 GET / HTTP/1.0
13459 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13460
13461 Output log:
13462 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13463
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013464language(<value>[,<default>])
13465 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13466 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13467 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13468 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13469 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13470 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13471 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13472 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13473 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013474 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013475 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13476 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013478 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013479
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013480 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13481 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013482
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013483 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13484 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13485 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13486 use_backend spanish if es
13487 use_backend french if fr
13488 use_backend english if en
13489 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013490
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013491length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013492 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13493 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13494 type. The result is of type integer.
13495
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013496lower
13497 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13498 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13499 type. The result is of type string.
13500
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013501ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13502 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13503 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13504 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13505 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13506 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13507 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13508
13509 Example :
13510
13511 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013512 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013513 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13514
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013515map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13516map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13517map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13518 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13519 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13520 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13521 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13522 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13523 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13524 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13525 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013526
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013527 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13528 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13529 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013530
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013531 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013532 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013534 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13535 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13536 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13537 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013538 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13539 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013540 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13541 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13542 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13543 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13544 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13545 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13546 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13547 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013548 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13549 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13550 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013551 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13552 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13553 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13554 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13555 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013556
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013557 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13558 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13559 the corresponding match text.
13560
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013561 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13562 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13563 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13564 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13565 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013566
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013567 Example :
13568
13569 # this is a comment and is ignored
13570 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13571 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13572 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13573 | | | `---------- value
13574 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13575 | `---------------------------- key
13576 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13577
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013578mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013579 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13580 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013581 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013582 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013583 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013584 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13585 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13586 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13587 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013588 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013589 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013590
13591mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013592 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013593 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13594 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013595 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013596 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013597 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013598 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13599 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13600 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13601 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013602 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013603 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013604
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013605nbsrv
13606 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13607 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13608 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13609 map lookup.
13610
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013611neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013612 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13613 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13614 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13615 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013616
13617not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013618 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013619 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013620 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013621 absence of a flag).
13622
13623odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013624 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013625 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13626
13627or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013628 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013629 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013630 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13631 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013632 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013633 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13634 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13635 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13636 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013637 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013638 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013639
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013640protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
13641 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
13642 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
13643 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
13644 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
13645 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13646 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13647 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13648 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
13649 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
13650 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13651 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
13652
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013653regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013654 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13655 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13656 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13657 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13658 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13659 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13660 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13661 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13662 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13663 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013664 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13665 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13666 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13667 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013668
13669 Example :
13670
13671 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13672 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13673 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13674 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13675
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013676capture-req(<id>)
13677 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13678 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13679
13680 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013681 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13682 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013683
13684capture-res(<id>)
13685 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13686 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13687
13688 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013689 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13690 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013691
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013692sdbm([<avalanche>])
13693 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13694 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13695 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13696 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13697 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13698 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13699 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013700 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13701 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013702
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013703set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013704 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13705 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13706 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013707 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013708 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13709 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013710 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013711 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13712 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013713 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013714 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013715
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013716sha1
13717 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13718 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13719
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013720strcmp(<var>)
13721 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13722 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13723 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13724 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13725 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13726 shorter).
13727
13728 Example :
13729
13730 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13731 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13732 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13733
13734
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013735sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013736 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13737 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013738 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013739 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13740 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013741 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013742 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13743 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013744 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013745 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13746 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013747 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013748 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013749
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013750table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13751 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13752 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13753 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13754 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13755 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13756 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13757
13758
13759table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13760 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13761 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13762 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13763 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13764 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13765 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13766
13767table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13768 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13769 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013770 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013771 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13772 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13773
13774table_conn_cur(<table>)
13775 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13776 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13777 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13778 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13779 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13780
13781table_conn_rate(<table>)
13782 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13783 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13784 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13785 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13786 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13787
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013788table_gpt0(<table>)
13789 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13790 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13791 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13792 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13793 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13794
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013795table_gpc0(<table>)
13796 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13797 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13798 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13799 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13800 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13801
13802table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13803 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13804 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13805 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13806 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13807 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13808 sample fetch keyword.
13809
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013810table_gpc1(<table>)
13811 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13812 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13813 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13814 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13815 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13816
13817table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13818 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13819 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13820 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13821 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13822 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13823 sample fetch keyword.
13824
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013825table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13826 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13827 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013828 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013829 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13830 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13831
13832table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13833 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13834 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13835 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13836 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13837 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13838 keyword.
13839
13840table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013843 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013844 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13845 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13846
13847table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13848 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13849 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13850 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13851 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13852 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13853 keyword.
13854
13855table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013859 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13860 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13861 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13862 keyword.
13863
13864table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13865 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13866 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013867 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013868 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13869 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13870 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13871 keyword.
13872
13873table_server_id(<table>)
13874 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13875 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13876 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13877 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13878 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13879 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13880
13881table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13882 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13883 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013884 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013885 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13886 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13887 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13888 keyword.
13889
13890table_sess_rate(<table>)
13891 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13892 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13893 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13894 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13895 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13896 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13897 keyword.
13898
13899table_trackers(<table>)
13900 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13901 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13902 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13903 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13904 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13905 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13906 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13907 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13908 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13909 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13910
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013911upper
13912 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13913 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13914 type. The result is of type string.
13915
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013916url_dec
13917 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13918 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13919
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013920ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013921 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013922 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
13923 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
13924 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013925 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
13926 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
13927 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
13928 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013929 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013930 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
13931 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013932
13933 Example:
13934 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
13935 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
13936
13937 message Point {
13938 int32 latitude = 1;
13939 int32 longitude = 2;
13940 }
13941
13942 message PPoint {
13943 Point point = 59;
13944 }
13945
13946 message Rectangle {
13947 // One corner of the rectangle.
13948 PPoint lo = 48;
13949 // The other corner of the rectangle.
13950 PPoint hi = 49;
13951 }
13952
13953 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
13954 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
13955 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
13956
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013957 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13958 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13959 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latidude" of "hi" second PPoint
13960 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
13961
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013962 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013963
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013964 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010013965
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010013966 As a gRPC message is alway made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
13967 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
13968 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
13969
13970 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
13971 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
13972 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
13973
13974 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
13975 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
13976 interpret the previous binary sample.
13977
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010013978
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013979unset-var(<var name>)
13980 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13981 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13982 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13983 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13984 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13985 response),
13986 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13987 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13988 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13989 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13990
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013991utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13992 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13993 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13994 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13995 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13996 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13997 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13998
13999 Example :
14000
14001 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014002 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014003 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14004
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014005word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14006 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14007 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14008 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14009 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14010 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14011
14012 Example :
14013 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14014 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14015 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14016 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14017 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014018
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014019wt6([<avalanche>])
14020 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14021 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14022 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14023 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14024 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14025 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14026 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014027 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14028 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014029
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014030xor(<value>)
14031 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014032 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014033 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014034 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014035 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014036 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14037 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014038 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014039 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14040 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014041 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014042 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014043
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014044xxh32([<seed>])
14045 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14046 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14047 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14048 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14049 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14050 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14051 as cryptographically secure.
14052
14053xxh64([<seed>])
14054 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14055 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14056 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14057 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14058 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14059 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14060 as cryptographically secure.
14061
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014062
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140637.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014064--------------------------------------------
14065
14066A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14067not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14068"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14069The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14070
14071always_false : boolean
14072 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14073 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14074
14075always_true : boolean
14076 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14077 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14078
14079avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014080 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014081 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14082 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14083 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14084 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14085 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14086 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14087 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14088 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14089 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14090 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14091 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14092 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14093 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014095be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014096 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14097 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14098 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14099 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014100 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14101
14102be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14103 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14104 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14105 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14106 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14107 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014108 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14109 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014110
14111 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14112 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14113 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014115be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14116 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14117 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14118 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014119 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014120 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14121 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014122
14123 Example :
14124 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14125 backend dynamic
14126 mode http
14127 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14128 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014129
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014130bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014131 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14132 of the string.
14133
14134bool(<bool>) : bool
14135 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14136 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014138connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14139 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014140 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014141 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14142 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014143
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014144 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014145 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014146 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14147
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014148 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14149 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014150
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014151 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014152 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014153 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014154 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014155 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014157 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014158
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014159 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14160 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014162 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014163
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014164cpu_calls : integer
14165 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14166 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14167 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14168 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14169 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14170 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14171
14172cpu_ns_avg : integer
14173 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14174 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14175 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14176 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14177 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14178 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14179 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14180 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14181 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14182 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14183 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14184
14185cpu_ns_tot : integer
14186 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14187 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14188 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14189 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14190 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14191 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14192 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14193 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14194 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14195 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14196 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14197 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14198 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14199
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014200date([<offset>]) : integer
14201 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14202 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14203 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14204 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014205 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14206
14207 Example :
14208
14209 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14210 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014211
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014212date_us : integer
14213 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14214 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14215 from the same timeval structure.
14216
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014217distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14218 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14219 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14220 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14221 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14222 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14223 list of supported tokens.
14224
14225distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14226 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14227 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14228 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14229 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14230 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14231 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14232 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14233 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14234 supported tokens.
14235
14236 Example :
14237 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14238 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14239 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14240 # send large files to the big farm
14241 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14242
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014243env(<name>) : string
14244 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14245 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14246 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14247 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14248 certain way.
14249
14250 Examples :
14251 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14252 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14253
14254 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14255 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014257fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14258 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014259 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14260 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014261 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14262 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014263 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14265 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014266
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014267fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14268 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14269 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14270 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14273 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14274 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14275 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14276 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14277 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14278 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14279 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14280 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014281
14282 Example :
14283 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14284 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14285 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14286 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14287 frontend mail
14288 bind :25
14289 mode tcp
14290 maxconn 100
14291 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14292 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14293 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14294 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014295
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014296hostname : string
14297 Returns the system hostname.
14298
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014299int(<integer>) : signed integer
14300 Returns a signed integer.
14301
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014302ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14303 Returns an ipv4.
14304
14305ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14306 Returns an ipv6.
14307
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014308lat_ns_avg : integer
14309 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14310 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14311 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14312 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14313 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14314 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14315 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14316 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14317 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14318 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14319 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14320 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14321 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14322 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14323
14324lat_ns_tot : integer
14325 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14326 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14327 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14328 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14329 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14330 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14331 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14332 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14333 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14334 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14335 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14336 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14337 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14338 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14339 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14340 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14341 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14342 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14343 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14344
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014345meth(<method>) : method
14346 Returns a method.
14347
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014348nbproc : integer
14349 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14350 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14351 and debugging purposes.
14352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014353nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14354 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14355 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14356 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014357 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14358 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14359 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014360
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014361prio_class : integer
14362 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14363 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14364 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14365
14366prio_offset : integer
14367 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14368 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14369 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14370 set-priority-offset".
14371
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014372proc : integer
14373 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14374 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14375 debugging purposes.
14376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014378 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14379 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14380 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14382 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14383 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14384 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14385 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14386
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014387rand([<range>]) : integer
14388 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14389 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14390 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14391 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14392 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14395 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14396 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14397 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14398 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14399 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014400 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14401 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14402
14403srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14405 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14406 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14407 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14408 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14409 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14410 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14411
14412 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14413 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014414
14415srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14416 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14417 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14418 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014419 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014420 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14421 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14422 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14423
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014424srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14425 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14426 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14427 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14428 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14429 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14430 fetch methods.
14431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014432srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14433 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14434 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014435 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14437 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014438 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439 overloading servers).
14440
14441 Example :
14442 # Redirect to a separate back
14443 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14444 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14445 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14446
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014447stopping : boolean
14448 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14449 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14450 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14451
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014452str(<string>) : string
14453 Returns a string.
14454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014455table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14456 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14457 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14458
14459table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14460 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14461 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14462 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14463
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014464thread : integer
14465 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14466 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14467 and debugging purposes.
14468
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014469var(<var-name>) : undefined
14470 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014471 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14472 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014476 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014477 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14478 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014479 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014480 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014481
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144827.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483----------------------------------
14484
14485The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14486closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14487methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14488sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14489TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014490the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14491counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014492"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14493used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14494can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14495Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14496table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14497tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14498currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014500bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014501 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14502 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14503 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505be_id : integer
14506 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14507 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14508
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014509be_name : string
14510 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14511 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014513dst : ip
14514 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14515 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14516 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14517 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014518 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14519 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14520 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14521 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14522 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14523 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524
14525dst_conn : integer
14526 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14527 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14528 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14529 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14530 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14531 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14532 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14533 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014534
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014535dst_is_local : boolean
14536 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14537 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14538 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14539 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014540 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014541 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14542 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14543 it only once per connection.
14544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545dst_port : integer
14546 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14547 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14548 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14549 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14550 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14551 an HTTP header.
14552
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014553fc_http_major : integer
14554 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14555 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14556 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14557
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014558fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14559 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14560 header.
14561
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014562fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14563 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14564 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14565 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14566 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14567 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14568 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14569
14570fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14571 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14572 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14573 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14574 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14575 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14576 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14577
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014578fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14579 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14580 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14581 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14582 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14583
14584fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14585 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14586 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14587 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14588 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14589
14590fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14591 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14592 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14593 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14594 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14595
14596fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14597 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14598 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14599 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14600 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14601
14602fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14603 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14604 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14605 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14606 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14607
14608fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14609 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14610 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14611 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14612 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14613
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014614fe_defbe : string
14615 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14616 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618fe_id : integer
14619 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014620 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14622
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014623fe_name : string
14624 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14625 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14626 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14627
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014628sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014629sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14630sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14631sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014632 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14633 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14634 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14635
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014636sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014637sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14638sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14639sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014640 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14641 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14642 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014644sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014645sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14646sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14647sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014648 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14649 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014650 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14651 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14652 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014653
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014654 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014655 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14656 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014657 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14658 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14659 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014660 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14661 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14662
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014663sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14664sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14665sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14666sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14667 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14668 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14669 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14670 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14671 when a first ACL was verified.
14672
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014673sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014674sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14675sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14676sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014677 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014678 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014680sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014681sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14682sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14683sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014684 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14685 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14686 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14687
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014688sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014689sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14690sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14691sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014692 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14693 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14694 See also src_conn_rate.
14695
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014696sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014697sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14698sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14699sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014700 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014701 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014702
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014703sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14704sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14705sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14706sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14707 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14708 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14709
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014710sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14711sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14712sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14713sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14714 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14715 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014717sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014718sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14719sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14720sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014721 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14722 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14723 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014724 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14725 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14726 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014727
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014728sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14729sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14730sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14731sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14732 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14733 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14734 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14735 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14736 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14737 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14738
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014739sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014740sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14741sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14742sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014743 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014744 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14745 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14746
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014747sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014748sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14749sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14750sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014751 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14752 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14753 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14754 src_http_err_rate.
14755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014756sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014757sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14758sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14759sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014760 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014761 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14762 src_http_req_cnt.
14763
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014764sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014765sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14766sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14767sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014768 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14769 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14770 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14771 src_http_req_rate.
14772
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014773sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014774sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14775sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14776sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014777 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014778 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14779 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14780 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14781 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014782
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014783 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014784 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14785 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014786 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14787
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014788sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14789sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14790sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14791sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14792 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14793 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14794 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14795 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14796 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14797
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014798sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014799sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14800sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14801sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014802 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14803 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14804 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014805
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014806sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014807sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14808sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14809sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014810 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14811 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14812 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014813
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014814sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014815sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14816sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14817sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014818 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014819 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14820 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14821 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014822 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014823 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14824
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014825sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014826sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14827sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14828sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014829 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14830 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14831 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14832 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14833 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014834 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014835
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014836sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014837sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14838sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14839sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014840 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14841 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14842 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14843
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014844sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014845sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14846sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14847sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014848 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14849 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014850 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014851 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14852 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014853 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14854 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14855 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014857so_id : integer
14858 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14859 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14860 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014863 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014864 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14865 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14866 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014867 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14868 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14869 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014870 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14871 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14872 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14873 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14874 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14875 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14876 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014877
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014878 Example:
14879 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14880 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14883 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14884 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14885 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014886 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14889 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14890 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014891 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014892 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14895 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14896 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14897 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14898 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14899 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14900 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014901
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014902 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014903 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14904 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14905 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14906 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014907 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014908 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14909 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14910
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014911src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14912 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14913 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14914 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14915 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14916 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14917 was verified.
14918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014920 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014921 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014922 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014923 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014925src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014926 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014927 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14928 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014929 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014931src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14932 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14933 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14934 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014935 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014937src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014938 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014940 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014941 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014942
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014943src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14944 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14945 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14946 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14947 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14948
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014949src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14950 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14951 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14952 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14953 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014955src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014956 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014958 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14959 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014960 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14961 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14962 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014963
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014964src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14965 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14966 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14967 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14968 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14969 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14970 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14971 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014973src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014974 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014976 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014977 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014978 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014980src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14981 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14982 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14983 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14984 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014985 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014987src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014988 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14990 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014991 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14994 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14995 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14996 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014997 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014998 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015000src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15001 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15002 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15003 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015004 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15006 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015007
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015008 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015009 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015010 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015011 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015012
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015013src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15014 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15015 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15016 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15017 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15018 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15019 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15020
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015021src_is_local : boolean
15022 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15023 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15024 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15025 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015026 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015027 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15028 once per connection.
15029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015030src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015031 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15032 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15033 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15034 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15035 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015038 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15039 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15040 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15041 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15042 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015044src_port : integer
15045 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15046 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15047 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15048 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015051 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015052 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15053 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15054 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015055 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015057src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15058 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15059 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15060 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15061 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015062 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015064src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15065 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15066 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15067 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15068 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15069 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15070 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15071 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15072 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015073
15074 Example :
15075 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15076 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15077 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15078 listen ssh
15079 bind :22
15080 mode tcp
15081 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015082 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015083 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015084 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086srv_id : integer
15087 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15088 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15089 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015090
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150917.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015092----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015094The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15095closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15096when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15097usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015098future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015099
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001510051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15101 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15102 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15103 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15104 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15105 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15106
15107 Example :
15108 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15109 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15110 # the request.
15111 frontend http-in
15112 bind *:8081
15113 default_backend servers
15114 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15115 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15116
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015117ssl_bc : boolean
15118 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15119 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15120 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15121
15122ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15123 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15124 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15125
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015126ssl_bc_alpn : string
15127 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15128 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15129 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15130 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15131 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15132 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15133 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15134 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15135 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15136
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015137ssl_bc_cipher : string
15138 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15139 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15140
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015141ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15142 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15143 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15144 session or a TLS ticket.
15145
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015146ssl_bc_npn : string
15147 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15148 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15149 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15150 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15151 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15152 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15153 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15154 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15155
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015156ssl_bc_protocol : string
15157 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15158 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15159
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015160ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015161 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015162 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15163 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015164
15165ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15166 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15167 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15168 if session was reused or not.
15169
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015170ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15171 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15172 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15173 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15174 BoringSSL.
15175
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015176ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15177 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15178 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015180ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15181 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15182 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15183 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15184 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15185 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015187ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15188 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15189 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15190 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15191 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015192
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015193ssl_c_der : binary
15194 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15195 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15196 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015198ssl_c_err : integer
15199 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15200 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15201 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15202 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15203 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015205ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15206 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15207 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15208 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15209 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15210 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15211 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15212 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15213 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215ssl_c_key_alg : string
15216 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15217 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15218 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015220ssl_c_notafter : string
15221 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15222 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15223 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015225ssl_c_notbefore : string
15226 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15227 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15228 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15231 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15232 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15233 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15234 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15235 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15236 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15237 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15238 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240ssl_c_serial : binary
15241 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15242 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15243 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15246 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15247 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15248 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015249 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15250 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15251
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015252 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015253 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15256 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15257 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15258 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015260ssl_c_used : boolean
15261 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15262 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015264ssl_c_verify : integer
15265 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15266 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15267 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15268 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015270ssl_c_version : integer
15271 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15272 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015273
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015274ssl_f_der : binary
15275 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15276 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15277 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015279ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15280 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15281 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15282 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15283 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015284 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015285 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15286 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15287 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289ssl_f_key_alg : string
15290 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15291 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15292 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015294ssl_f_notafter : string
15295 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15296 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15297 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015299ssl_f_notbefore : string
15300 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15301 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15302 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15305 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15306 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15307 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15308 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15309 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15310 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15311 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15312 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015313
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314ssl_f_serial : binary
15315 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15316 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15317 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015318
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015319ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15320 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15321 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15322 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015324ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15325 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15326 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15327 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015329ssl_f_version : integer
15330 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15331 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15332
15333ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015334 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15335 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15336 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015338 Example :
15339 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15340 listen http-https
15341 bind :80
15342 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15343 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15344
15345ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15346 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15347 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15348
15349ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015350 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015351 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15352 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15353 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15354 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15355 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15356 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15357 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15358 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015360ssl_fc_cipher : string
15361 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15362 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015363
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015364ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15365 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15366 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015367 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015368
15369ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15370 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15371 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015372 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015373
15374ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15375 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15376 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15377 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015378 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015379 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015380
15381ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15382 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15383 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015384 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015387 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15388 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015389 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15390 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15391 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15392 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015393
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015394ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15395 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15396 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15397 wait until the handshake happened.
15398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15400 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015401 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15402 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15403 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15404 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015405
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015406ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015407 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015408 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15409 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015412 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015413 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15414 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15415 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15416 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15417 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15418 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15419 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015421ssl_fc_protocol : string
15422 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15423 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015424
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015425ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015426 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015427 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15428 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015429
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015430ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15431 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15432 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15433 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15434 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015435
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015436ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15437 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15438 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15439 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15440 BoringSSL.
15441
15442
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015443ssl_fc_sni : string
15444 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15445 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15446 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15447 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15448 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15449
15450 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15451 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15452 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015453 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15454 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015456 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015457 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15458 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15461 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15462 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015463
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015464
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154657.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015466------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015468Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15469sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15470only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15471For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15472be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15473can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15474sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15475for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15476content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015478payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015479 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15481 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015483payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15484 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015485 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015487
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015488req.hdrs : string
15489 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15490 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15491 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15492 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15493
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015494req.hdrs_bin : binary
15495 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15496 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15497 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15498 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15499 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15500 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15501
15502 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15503
15504 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15505 str: <int:length><bytes>
15506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507req.len : integer
15508req_len : integer (deprecated)
15509 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15510 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15511 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15512 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15513 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15514 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15515 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15516 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015518req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15519 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015520 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15521 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15522 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15523 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015525 ACL alternatives :
15526 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015528req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15529 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15530 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15531 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15532 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534 ACL alternatives :
15535 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015537 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539req.proto_http : boolean
15540req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15541 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15542 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15543 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15544 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15545 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15546 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15547 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015548
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015549 Example:
15550 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15551 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15552 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015553 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15556rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15557 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15558 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15559 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15560 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15561 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15562 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15563 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15566 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15567 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15568 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15569 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15570 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015572 ACL derivatives :
15573 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015575 Example :
15576 listen tse-farm
15577 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15578 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15579 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15580 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15581 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15582 persist rdp-cookie
15583 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15584 # This is only useful makes sense if
15585 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15586 stick-table type string size 204800
15587 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15588 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15589 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15592 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15595rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15596 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15597 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15598 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15599 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601 ACL derivatives :
15602 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015603
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015604req.ssl_alpn : string
15605 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15606 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15607 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15608 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15609 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15610 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015611 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015612
15613 Examples :
15614 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15615 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15616 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015617 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015618 default_backend bk_default
15619
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015620req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15621 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15622 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015623 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15624 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15625 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15626 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15627 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15630req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15631 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15632 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15633 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15634 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15635 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15636 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15637 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639req.ssl_sni : string
15640req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15641 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15642 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15643 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15644 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15645 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15646 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15647 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15648 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15649 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15650 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15651 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15652 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 ACL derivatives :
15655 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 Examples :
15658 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15659 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15660 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15661 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15662 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015663
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015664req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15665 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15666 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15667 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15668 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15669 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15670 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15671 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15672 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15673 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015675req.ssl_ver : integer
15676req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15677 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15678 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15679 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15680 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15681 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15682 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15683 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015684 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015685 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 ACL derivatives :
15688 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015689
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015690res.len : integer
15691 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15692 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15693 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15694 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15695 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15696 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15697 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15698 content inspection.
15699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015700res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15701 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015702 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15703 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15704 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15705 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15708 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15709 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15710 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15711 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015714
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015715res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15716rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15717 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15718 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15719 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15720 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15721 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15722 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15723 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725wait_end : boolean
15726 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15727 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015728 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15730 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015731 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015732 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15733 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015735 Examples :
15736 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15737 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15738 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015740 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15741 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15742 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15743 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15744 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15745 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15746 tcp-request content reject
15747
15748
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157497.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015750--------------------------------------
15751
15752It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15753This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15754data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15755its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15756HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15757content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15758to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15759more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15760response are indexed.
15761
15762base : string
15763 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15764 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15765 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15766 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15767 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15768 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15769 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15770 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15771
15772 ACL derivatives :
15773 base : exact string match
15774 base_beg : prefix match
15775 base_dir : subdir match
15776 base_dom : domain match
15777 base_end : suffix match
15778 base_len : length match
15779 base_reg : regex match
15780 base_sub : substring match
15781
15782base32 : integer
15783 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15784 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15785 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015786 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15787 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15788 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015789
15790base32+src : binary
15791 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15792 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15793 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15794 per-URL counters.
15795
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015796capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15797 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15798 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15799 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15800
15801capture.req.method : string
15802 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15803 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15804 because it's allocated.
15805
15806capture.req.uri : string
15807 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15808 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15809 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15810 allocated.
15811
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015812capture.req.ver : string
15813 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15814 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15815 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15816
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015817capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15818 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15819 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15820 The first entry is an index of 0.
15821 See also: "capture response header"
15822
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015823capture.res.ver : string
15824 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15825 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15826 persistent flag.
15827
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015828req.body : binary
15829 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15830 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15831 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15832 the first chunk is analyzed.
15833
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015834req.body_param([<name>) : string
15835 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15836 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15837 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15838 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15839 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15840 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15841 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15842 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15843 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15844 given.
15845
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015846req.body_len : integer
15847 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15848 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15849 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15850 "option http-buffer-request".
15851
15852req.body_size : integer
15853 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15854 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15855 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15856 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15857 "option http-buffer-request".
15858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015859req.cook([<name>]) : string
15860cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15861 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15862 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15863 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15864 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15865 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15866 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15867 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15868 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15869
15870 ACL derivatives :
15871 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15872 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15873 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15874 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15875 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15876 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15877 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15878 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15881cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15882 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15883 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015885req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15886cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15887 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15888 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15889 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15890 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15893 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15894 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15895 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15896 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015897 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015898 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15899 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15900 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15901 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015903hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15904 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15905 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15906 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15907 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015908 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015910req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15911 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15912 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15913 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15914 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15915 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15916 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15917 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15918 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15921 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15922 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15923 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15924 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15927 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15928 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15929 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15930 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15931 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15932 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15933 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15934 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015935 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015937 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015939 ACL derivatives :
15940 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15941 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15942 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15943 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15944 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15945 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15946 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15947 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15948
15949req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15950hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15951 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15952 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15953 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15954 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15955 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15956 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15957 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15958 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15959 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15960
15961req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15962hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15963 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15964 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15965 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15966 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15967 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015968 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15970 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15971
15972req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15973hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15974 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15975 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15976 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15977 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15978 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15979 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15980 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15981
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010015982
15983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015984http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15985 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15986 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15987 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15988 basic auth is supported.
15989
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015990http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15991 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15992 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15993 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15994 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015995 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15996 basic auth is supported.
15997
15998 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015999 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16000 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16001 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16002 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016003
16004http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016005 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16006 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16008 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016010method : integer + string
16011 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16012 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16013 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16014 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16015 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16016 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16017 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019 ACL derivatives :
16020 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016022 Example :
16023 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16024 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16025 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027path : string
16028 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16029 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16030 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16031 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16032 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016033 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016036 ACL derivatives :
16037 path : exact string match
16038 path_beg : prefix match
16039 path_dir : subdir match
16040 path_dom : domain match
16041 path_end : suffix match
16042 path_len : length match
16043 path_reg : regex match
16044 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016045
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016046query : string
16047 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16048 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16049 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16050 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016051 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016052 which stops before the question mark.
16053
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016054req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16055 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16056 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16057 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16058 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060req.ver : string
16061req_ver : string (deprecated)
16062 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16063 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16064 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016066 ACL derivatives :
16067 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016069res.comp : boolean
16070 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16071 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16072 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074res.comp_algo : string
16075 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16076 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16077 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016079res.cook([<name>]) : string
16080scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16081 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16082 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16083 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016085 ACL derivatives :
16086 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016088res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16089scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16090 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16091 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16092 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016094res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16095scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16096 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16097 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16098 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016100res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16101 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16102 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16103 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16104 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16105 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16106 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16107 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16108 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16109 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16112 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16113 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16114 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16115 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16116 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016118res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16119shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16120 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16121 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16122 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16123 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16124 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16125 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16126 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16127 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016129 ACL derivatives :
16130 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16131 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16132 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16133 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16134 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16135 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16136 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16137 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16138
16139res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16140shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16141 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16142 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16143 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16144 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16145 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016146
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016147res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16148shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16149 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16150 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16151 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16152 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16153 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16154 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016155
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016156res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16157 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16158 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16159 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16160 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016162res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16163shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16164 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16165 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16166 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16167 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16168 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16169 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171res.ver : string
16172resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16173 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16174 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016176 ACL derivatives :
16177 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016179set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16180 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16181 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016182 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016183 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016185 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16186 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016188status : integer
16189 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16190 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16191 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016192
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016193unique-id : string
16194 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16195 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16196 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16197 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16198 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16199 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016201url : string
16202 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16203 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16204 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16205 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16206 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16207 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16208 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016210 ACL derivatives :
16211 url : exact string match
16212 url_beg : prefix match
16213 url_dir : subdir match
16214 url_dom : domain match
16215 url_end : suffix match
16216 url_len : length match
16217 url_reg : regex match
16218 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016220url_ip : ip
16221 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16222 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16223 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16224 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16225 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16226 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16227 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016229url_port : integer
16230 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16231 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16232 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16233 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016234
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016235urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16236url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016237 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16238 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016239 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16240 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16241 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16242 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016243 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16244 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016245 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16246 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016248 ACL derivatives :
16249 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16250 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16251 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16252 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16253 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16254 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16255 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16256 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016257
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016259 Example :
16260 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16261 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16262 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16263 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016264
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016265urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016266 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16267 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16268 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016269
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016270url32 : integer
16271 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16272 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16273 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16274 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16275 is an unsigned integer.
16276
16277url32+src : binary
16278 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16279 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16280 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16281
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162837.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016284---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016285
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016286Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16287every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016288order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016289
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016290ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16291---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016292FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016293HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016294HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16295HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016296HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16297HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16298HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16299HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16300LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016301METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016302METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016303METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16304METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16305METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16306METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016307METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016308METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016309RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016310REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016311TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016312WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16313---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016314
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163168. Logging
16317----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016318
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016319One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16320provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16321very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16322provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16323state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016324to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016325headers.
16326
16327In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16328about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16329send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16330
16331 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16332 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16333 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16334 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16335 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016336 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016337 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016338
16339The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16340allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16341as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16342while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16343real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16344delay.
16345
16346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163478.1. Log levels
16348---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016349
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016350TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016351source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016352HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16353in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16354track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16355syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16356about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016357
16358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163598.2. Log formats
16360----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016361
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016362HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016363and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16364slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16365options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016366
16367 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16368 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16369 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16370 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16371 extents.
16372
16373 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16374 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16375 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16376 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16377 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16378
16379 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16380 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16381 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16382 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16383 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16384
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016385 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16386 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16387 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16388 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16389
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016390 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16391
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016392Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16393specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16394field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16395servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16396always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16397identifier.
16398
16399Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16400 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16401 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16402 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16403 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16404
16405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164068.2.1. Default log format
16407-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016408
16409This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16410as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16411format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16412
16413 Example :
16414 listen www
16415 mode http
16416 log global
16417 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16418
16419 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16420 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16421 (www/HTTP)
16422
16423 Field Format Extract from the example above
16424 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16425 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16426 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16427 4 'to' to
16428 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16429 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16430
16431Detailed fields description :
16432 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16433 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16434 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16435 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16436 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16437 and processed the connection.
16438 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16439
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016440In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16441"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16442connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16443
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016444It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16445will eventually disappear.
16446
16447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164488.2.2. TCP log format
16449---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016450
16451The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16452is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16453information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16454counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16455emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16456environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16457the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16458sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016459specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16460not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16461fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16462marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016463
16464 Example :
16465 frontend fnt
16466 mode tcp
16467 option tcplog
16468 log global
16469 default_backend bck
16470
16471 backend bck
16472 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16473
16474 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16475 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16476 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16477
16478 Field Format Extract from the example above
16479 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16480 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16481 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16482 4 frontend_name fnt
16483 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16484 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16485 7 bytes_read* 212
16486 8 termination_state --
16487 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16488 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16489
16490Detailed fields description :
16491 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016492 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16493 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16494 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016495 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016496 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016497 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016498
16499 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016500 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16501 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16502 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016503
16504 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16505 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16506 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016507 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16508 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16509 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16510 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016511
16512 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16513 and processed the connection.
16514
16515 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16516 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16517 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16518 applications.
16519
16520 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16521 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16522 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16523 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16524 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16525
16526 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16527 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16528 See "Timers" below for more details.
16529
16530 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16531 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16532 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16533 "Timers" below for more details.
16534
16535 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016536 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016537 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16538 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16539 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16540 details.
16541
16542 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16543 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16544 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16545 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16546 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16547
16548 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16549 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16550 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16551 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16552 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16553 for more details.
16554
16555 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016556 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016557 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16558 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16559 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016560 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016561
16562 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16563 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16564 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16565 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16566 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16567 caused by a denial of service attack.
16568
16569 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16570 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16571 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16572 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16573 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16574 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16575 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16576 denial of service attack.
16577
16578 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16579 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16580 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16581 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16582 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16583 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16584 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16585 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16586 be processed than on other servers.
16587
16588 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16589 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16590 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16591 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16592 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16593 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16594 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16595 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16596 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16597 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16598 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16599 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16600 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16601
16602 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16603 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16604 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16605 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16606 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16607 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016608 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016609 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16610
16611 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16612 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16613 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16614 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16615 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16616 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016617 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016618 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16619 occurs.
16620
16621
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166228.2.3. HTTP log format
16623----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016624
16625The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16626is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16627the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16628are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16629emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16630generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16631"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16632which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016633frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16634is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016635
16636Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16637slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16638with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16639
16640 Example :
16641 frontend http-in
16642 mode http
16643 option httplog
16644 log global
16645 default_backend bck
16646
16647 backend static
16648 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16649
16650 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16651 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16652 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016653 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016654
16655 Field Format Extract from the example above
16656 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16657 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016658 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016659 4 frontend_name http-in
16660 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016661 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016662 7 status_code 200
16663 8 bytes_read* 2750
16664 9 captured_request_cookie -
16665 10 captured_response_cookie -
16666 11 termination_state ----
16667 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16668 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16669 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16670 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16671 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016672
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016673Detailed fields description :
16674 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016675 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16676 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16677 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016678 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016679 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016680 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016681
16682 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016683 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16684 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16685 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016686
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016687 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16688 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016689
16690 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16691 and processed the connection.
16692
16693 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16694 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16695 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16696
16697 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16698 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16699 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16700 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16701 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16702 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16703
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016704 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16705 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16706 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16707 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16708 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16709 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016710 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16711 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016712
16713 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16714 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016715 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016716
16717 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16718 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016719 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16720 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016721
16722 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16723 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16724 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16725 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16726 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016727 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16728 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016729
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016730 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16731 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16732 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16733 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16734 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16735 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16736 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016737 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016738
16739 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16740 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16741 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16742
16743 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16744 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16745 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16746 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16747 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16748 overflowing.
16749
16750 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16751 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16752 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16753 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16754 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16755 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16756 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16757 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16758
16759 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16760 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16761 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16762 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16763 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16764 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16765 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16766 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16767
16768 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16769 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16770 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16771 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16772 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16773 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16774 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16775
16776 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016777 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016778 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16779 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16780 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016781 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016782 system.
16783
16784 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16785 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16786 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16787 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16788 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16789 caused by a denial of service attack.
16790
16791 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16792 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16793 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16794 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16795 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16796 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16797 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16798 denial of service attack.
16799
16800 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16801 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16802 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16803 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16804 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16805 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16806 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16807 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16808 processed than on other servers.
16809
16810 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16811 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16812 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16813 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16814 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16815 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16816 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16817 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16818 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16819 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16820 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16821 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16822 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16823
16824 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16825 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16826 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16827 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16828 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16829 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016830 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016831 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16832
16833 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16834 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16835 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16836 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16837 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16838 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016839 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016840 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16841 occurs.
16842
16843 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16844 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16845 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16846 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16847 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16848 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16849 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16850 cookies" below for more details.
16851
16852 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16853 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16854 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16855 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16856 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16857 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16858 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16859 and cookies" below for more details.
16860
16861 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16862 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16863 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16864 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16865 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16866 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16867 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16868 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16869
16870
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168718.2.4. Custom log format
16872------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016873
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016874The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016875mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016876
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016877HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016878Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16879separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16880prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16881
16882Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16883variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016884("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016885
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016886If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016887as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016888less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16889the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16890
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016891Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016892In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016893in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016894
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016895Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16896'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16897https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16898such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16899
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016900Flags are :
16901 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016902 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016903 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16904 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016905
16906 Example:
16907
16908 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16909 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16910
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016911 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16912
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016913At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16914
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016915 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16916 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016917
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016918the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016919
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016920 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16921 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16922 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016923
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016924and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16925
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016926 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16927 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016928
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016929Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16930
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016931 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016932 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016933 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16934 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16935 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016936 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16937 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16938 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016939 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016940 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16941 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016942 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016943 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16944 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016945 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016946 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016947 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016948 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016949 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016950 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016951 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016952 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16953 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16954 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16955 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16956 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016957 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016958 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16959 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016960 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016961 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16962 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016963 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16964 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16965 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016966 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016967 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16968 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016969 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016970 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16971 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16972 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016973 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016974 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016975 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16976 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16977 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16978 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016979 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016980 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016981 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016982 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016983 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016984 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016985 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16986 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16987 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016988 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016989 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16990 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016991 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016992 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16993 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016994 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016995 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016996 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016997 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016998
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016999 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017000
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017001
170028.2.5. Error log format
17003-----------------------
17004
17005When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17006protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17007By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17008"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017009will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017010logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17011
17012The format looks like this :
17013
17014 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17015 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17016 Connection error during SSL handshake
17017
17018 Field Format Extract from the example above
17019 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17020 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17021 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17022 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17023 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17024
17025These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17026failures.
17027
17028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170298.3. Advanced logging options
17030-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017031
17032Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17033just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17034options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17035for more information about their usage.
17036
17037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170388.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17039------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017040
17041It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17042haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17043commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17044monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17045ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17046
17047 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17048 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17049 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17050 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17051
17052 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17053 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17054 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017055 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017056 such as other load-balancers.
17057
17058 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17059 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17060 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17061
17062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170638.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17064----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017065
17066The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17067what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17068or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017069"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017070just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17071log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17072after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17073is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17074with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17075with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17076
17077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170788.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17079------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017080
17081Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17082for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17083"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17084retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17085raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17086a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17087file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17088you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17089"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17090
17091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17093--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017094
17095Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17096multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17097them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17098"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17099logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17100error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17101and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17102too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17103useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17104alternative.
17105
17106
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171078.4. Timing events
17108------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017109
17110Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17111reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17112the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17113frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017114mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17115addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17116
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017117Timings events in HTTP mode:
17118
17119 first request 2nd request
17120 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17121 t tr t tr ...
17122 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17123 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17124 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17125 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17126 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17127
17128Timings events in TCP mode:
17129
17130 TCP session
17131 |<----------------->|
17132 t t
17133 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17134 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17135 |<------ Tt ------->|
17136
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017137 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017138 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017139 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17140 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17141 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017142 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017143 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17144 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17145 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17146 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017147
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017148 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17149 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17150 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017151 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17152 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17153 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17154 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17155 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17156 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017157
17158 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17159 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17160 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17161 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17162 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17163 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17164 request typed by hand during a test.
17165
17166 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17167 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017168 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017169 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17170 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17171 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17172 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017173
17174 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17175 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17176 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17177 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17178 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17179
17180 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17181 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17182 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17183 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17184 connection never established.
17185
17186 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17187 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17188 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17189 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17190 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17191 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17192 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17193 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17194 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17195 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17196 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17197
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017198 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17199 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17200 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17201 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17202 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17203 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17204
17205 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17206
17207 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17208 "Ta" can never be negative.
17209
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017210 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17211 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017212 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17213 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017214 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017216 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017217
17218 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017219 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17220 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017221
17222These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17223protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17224that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017225due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17226"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17227that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017228
17229Most common cases :
17230
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017231 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17232 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17233 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17234 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17235 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17236 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17237 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17238 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17239 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17240 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17241 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017242 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017243
17244 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17245 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17246 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17247 of ms on remote networks.
17248
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017249 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17250 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17251 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017252
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017253 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17254 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17255 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17256 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17257 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17258 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17259 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17260 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17261 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017262
17263Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17264
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017265 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017266 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017267 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017268
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017269 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017270 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17271 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17272
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017273 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017274 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17275 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17276 flags.
17277
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017278 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17279 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017280 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17281 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17282 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17283 the client connection was maintained open.
17284
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017285 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017286 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017287 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017288 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17289
17290
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172918.5. Session state at disconnection
17292-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017293
17294TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17295"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172962-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17297each of which has a special meaning :
17298
17299 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17300 session to terminate :
17301
17302 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17303
17304 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17305 server explicitly refused it.
17306
17307 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17308 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17309 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17310 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017311 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017312
17313 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17314 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017315
17316 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17317 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17318 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17319 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17320 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17321
17322 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17323 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17324 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17325 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17326 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17327
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017328 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17329 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17330
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017331 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17332 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17333 backup connections when going up.
17334
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017335 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17336
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017337 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17338 send or receive data.
17339
17340 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17341 send or receive data.
17342
17343 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17344 with nothing left in the buffers.
17345
17346 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17347
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017348 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017349 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17350
17351 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17352 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17353 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17354 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17355 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17356
17357 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17358 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17359
17360 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17361 server (HTTP only).
17362
17363 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17364
17365 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17366 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17367 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17368
17369 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17370 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17371 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17372
17373 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17374
17375 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17376 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17377
17378 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17379 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17380 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17381
17382 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17383 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017384 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17385 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017386
17387 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17388 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17389 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17390 another server.
17391
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017392 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017393 server.
17394
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017395 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17396 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17397 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17398 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17399
17400 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17401 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17402 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17403 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17404
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017405 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17406 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17407 "use-server" rule).
17408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017409 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17410
17411 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17412 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17413
17414 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17415
17416 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17417 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17418 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17419
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017420 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17421 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017422 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017423 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17424 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17425
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017426 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17427
17428 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17429 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17430
17431 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17432
17433 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17434
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017435The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17436was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017437helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17438starvation, attacks, etc...
17439
17440The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17441alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17442easier finding and understanding.
17443
17444 Flags Reason
17445
17446 -- Normal termination.
17447
17448 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17449 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17450 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17451 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17452
17453 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17454 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17455 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17456 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17457 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17458 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017459
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017460 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17461 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017462 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017463
17464 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17465 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17466 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17467
17468 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17469 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17470 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17471 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17472 the server takes too long to respond.
17473
17474 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17475 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17476 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17477 long a time to respond.
17478
17479 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17480 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17481 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17482 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017483 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17484 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017485
17486 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17487 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17488 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17489 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17490 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017491 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017492 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17493 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17494 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17495 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17496 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17497 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17498 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17499 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017500 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017501 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17502 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17503 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017504
17505 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17506 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017507 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17508 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17509 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17510 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017511
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017512 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17513 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17514
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017515 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017516 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17517 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017518 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017519 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17520 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17521
17522 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17523 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17524 503 or 504 here.
17525
17526 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17527 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17528 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17529 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17530 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17531
17532 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17533 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017534 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017535 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17536 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17537
17538 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17539 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17540 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17541 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17542 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17543 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17544 between haproxy and the server.
17545
17546 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17547 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17548 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17549 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17550 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17551 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17552 solution is to fix the application.
17553
17554 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17555 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17556 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17557 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17558 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17559 external attacks.
17560
17561 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17562 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017563 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017564 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17565 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17566
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017567 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17568 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17569 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017570 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017571 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017572
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017573 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17574 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17575 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17576 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017577 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17578 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17579 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17580 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17581 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017582
17583 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17584 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17585 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17586 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17587
17588 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17589 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17590 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17591 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17592
17593 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17594 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17595 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17596 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17597
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017598The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17599persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17600important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17601re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17602
17603 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17604
17605 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17606 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17607 set on a GET request.
17608
17609 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17610 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017611 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017612 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17613
17614 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17615 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17616 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17617
17618 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17619 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17620 already got a cookie.
17621
17622 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17623 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17624 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17625 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17626 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17627
17628 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17629 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17630 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17631
17632 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17633 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17634 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17635
17636 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17637 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17638
17639 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17640 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17641 then advertised in the response.
17642
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176448.6. Non-printable characters
17645-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017646
17647In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17648consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17649converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17650prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17651being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17652escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17653is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17654'}' when logging headers.
17655
17656Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17657issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17658containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17659
17660Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17661the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17662performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17663
17664
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176658.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17666---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017667
17668Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17669achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017670section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017671cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17672the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17673the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017674locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017675not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17676user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17677a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17678wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17679
17680 Examples :
17681 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17682 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17683
17684 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17685 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17686
17687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17689---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017690
17691Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17692proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17693the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17694server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17695
17696Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17697response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017698section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017699
17700It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017701time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17702appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017703are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17704and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17705follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17706request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17707in the logs.
17708
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017709As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17710frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17711an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17712
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017713 Example :
17714 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17715 listen proxy-out
17716 mode http
17717 option httplog
17718 option logasap
17719 log global
17720 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17721
17722 # log the name of the virtual server
17723 capture request header Host len 20
17724
17725 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17726 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17727
17728 # log the beginning of the referrer
17729 capture request header Referer len 20
17730
17731 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17732 capture response header Server len 20
17733
17734 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17735 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17736
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017737 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017738 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17739
17740 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17741 capture response header Via len 20
17742
17743 # log the URL location during a redirection
17744 capture response header Location len 20
17745
17746 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17747 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17748 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17749 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17750 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17751
17752 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17753 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17754 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17755 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017756 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017757
17758 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17759 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17760 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17761 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17762 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017763 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017764
17765
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177668.9. Examples of logs
17767---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017768
17769These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17770them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17771reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17772
17773 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17774 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17775 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17776
17777 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17778 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17779
17780 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17781 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17782 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17783
17784 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17785 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17786
17787 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17788 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17789 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17790
17791 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017792 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017793 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17794 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17795
17796 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17797 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17798 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17799
17800 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17801 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017802 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017803 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17804 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17805 to return the 502 and not the server.
17806
17807 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017808 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017809
17810 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17811 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17812 Nothing was sent to any server.
17813
17814 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17815 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17816
17817 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17818 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017819 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017820 send a 408 return code to the client.
17821
17822 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17823 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17824
17825 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17826 5 seconds ("c----").
17827
17828 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17829 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017830 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017831
17832 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017833 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017834 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17835 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17836 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17837 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17838 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017839
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017840
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200178419. Supported filters
17842--------------------
17843
17844Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17845accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17846unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17847
17848See also : "filter"
17849
178509.1. Trace
17851----------
17852
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017853filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017854
17855 Arguments:
17856 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17857 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17858
17859 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17860 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17861 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17862 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17863
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017864 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017865 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17866 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17867 amount of the parsed data.
17868
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017869 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017870
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017871This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17872callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17873information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17874filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17875
17876Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17877tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17878a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17879
17880
178819.2. HTTP compression
17882---------------------
17883
17884filter compression
17885
17886The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17887keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017888when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17889it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17890response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17891line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17892cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17893the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017894
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017895See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017896
17897
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178989.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17899--------------------------------------------
17900
17901filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17902
17903 Arguments :
17904
17905 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17906 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17907 parsed.
17908
17909 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17910 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17911 part must be placed in its own scope.
17912
17913The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17914external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017915streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017916exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17917also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17918
17919SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17920the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17921
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017922For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017923"doc/SPOE.txt".
17924
17925Important note:
17926 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17927 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17928
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100179299.4. Cache
17930----------
17931
17932filter cache <name>
17933
17934 Arguments :
17935
17936 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17937
17938The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17939"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17940cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017941other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17942the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17943mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17944filter other than the compression is used for the same
17945listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17946order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017947
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017948See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017949
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001795010. Cache
17951---------
17952
17953HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17954(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17955RAM.
17956
17957The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017958this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017959
17960If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17961independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17962when we try to allocate a new one.
17963
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017964The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017965
17966It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17967"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17968for more details.
17969
17970When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17971replaced by "<CACHE>".
17972
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001797310.1. Limitation
17974----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017975
17976The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17977
17978- If the response is not a 200
17979- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017980- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017981- If the response is not cacheable
17982
17983- If the request is not a GET
17984- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017985- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017986
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017987Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17988filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17989can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17990example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17991"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017992
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001799310.2. Setup
17994-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017995
17996To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17997the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17998
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001799910.2.1. Cache section
18000---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018001
18002cache <name>
18003 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18004 size of cache is mandatory.
18005
18006total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018007 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018008 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018009
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018010max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018011 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18012 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18013 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018014
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018015max-age <seconds>
18016 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18017 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18018 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18019 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18020 default.
18021
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001802210.2.2. Proxy section
18023---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018024
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018025http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018026 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18027 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18028 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18029 after this one.
18030
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018031http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018032 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18033 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18034 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18035 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18036
18037
18038Example:
18039
18040 backend bck1
18041 mode http
18042
18043 http-request cache-use foobar
18044 http-response cache-store foobar
18045 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18046
18047 cache foobar
18048 total-max-size 4
18049 max-age 240
18050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018051/*
18052 * Local variables:
18053 * fill-column: 79
18054 * End:
18055 */